blob: e2fe0df9e32a99bd1259542b54e24d48289c7d37 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaua3393952014-05-10 15:16:43 +02007 2014/05/10
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200627. Using ACLs and fetching samples
637.1. ACL basics
647.1.1. Matching booleans
657.1.2. Matching integers
667.1.3. Matching strings
677.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
687.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
697.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
707.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
717.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200727.3.1. Converters
737.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
747.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
757.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
767.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
777.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200787.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079
808. Logging
818.1. Log levels
828.2. Log formats
838.2.1. Default log format
848.2.2. TCP log format
858.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100868.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100878.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200888.3. Advanced logging options
898.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
908.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
918.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
928.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
938.4. Timing events
948.5. Session state at disconnection
958.6. Non-printable characters
968.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
978.8. Capturing HTTP headers
988.9. Examples of logs
99
1009. Statistics and monitoring
1019.1. CSV format
1029.2. Unix Socket commands
103
104
1051. Quick reminder about HTTP
106----------------------------
107
108When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
109fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
110on almost anything found in the contents.
111
112However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
113formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
114correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
115
116
1171.1. The HTTP transaction model
118-------------------------------
119
120The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100121to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
123connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
124will involve a new connection :
125
126 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
127
128In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
129establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
130by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
131length.
132
133Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
134to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
135however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
136response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
137header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
138
139 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
140
141Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
142power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
143but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200144a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200145
146A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
147keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
148second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
149page :
150
151 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
152
153This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
154latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
155correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
156the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100157server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100159By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
160connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
161leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
162start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200163
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100164HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
165 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
166 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
167 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
168 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
169 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
170 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
171
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172
1731.2. HTTP request
174-----------------
175
176First, let's consider this HTTP request :
177
178 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100179 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
181 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
182 3 User-agent: my small browser
183 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
184 5 Accept: image/png
185
186
1871.2.1. The Request line
188-----------------------
189
190Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
191
192 - a METHOD : GET
193 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
194 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
195
196All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
197which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
198followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
199is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
200desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
201the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
202
203The URI itself can have several forms :
204
205 - A "relative URI" :
206
207 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
208
209 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
210 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
211
212 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
213
214 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
215
216 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
217 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
218 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
219 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
220 must accept this form too.
221
222 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
223 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
224 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100225
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200226 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
227 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
228 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
229 other protocols too.
230
231In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
232mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
233on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
234It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
235specific to the language, framework or application in use.
236
237
2381.2.2. The request headers
239--------------------------
240
241The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
242beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
243an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
244Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
245values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
246encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
247the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
248define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
249
250Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
251their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
252"Connection:" header).
253
254The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
255that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
256is one valid form of empty line.
257
258Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
259headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
260about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
261application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
262
263Important note:
264 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
265 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
266 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
267 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
268
269
2701.3. HTTP response
271------------------
272
273An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
274messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
275
276 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100277 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200278 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
279 2 Content-length: 350
280 3 Content-Type: text/html
281
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200282As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
283codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
284response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100285continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
286the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
287following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
288sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
289(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
290correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
291such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
292state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
293over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
294if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
295information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200296
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200297
2981.3.1. The Response line
299------------------------
300
301Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
302
303 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
304 - a status code : 200
305 - a reason : OK
306
307The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200308 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200309 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
310 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
311 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
312 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
313
314Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100315"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200316found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
317messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
318or "Authentication Required".
319
320Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
321
322 Code When / reason
323 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
324 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
325 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
326 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100327 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
328 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200329 400 for an invalid or too large request
330 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
331 accessing the stats page)
332 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
333 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
334 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
335 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
336 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
337 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
338 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
339 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
340 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
341
342The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3434.2).
344
345
3461.3.2. The response headers
347---------------------------
348
349Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
350the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
351details.
352
353
3542. Configuring HAProxy
355----------------------
356
3572.1. Configuration file format
358------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200359
360HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
361
362 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
363 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
364 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
365 "frontend" and "backend".
366
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100367The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
368referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
369delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100370preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100371escaped by doubling them.
372
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200373
3742.2. Time format
375----------------
376
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100377Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100378values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
379otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
380numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
381for every keyword. Supported units are :
382
383 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
384 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
385 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
386 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
387 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
388 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
389
390
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003912.3. Examples
392-------------
393
394 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
395 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
396 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
397 global
398 daemon
399 maxconn 256
400
401 defaults
402 mode http
403 timeout connect 5000ms
404 timeout client 50000ms
405 timeout server 50000ms
406
407 frontend http-in
408 bind *:80
409 default_backend servers
410
411 backend servers
412 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
413
414
415 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
416 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
417 global
418 daemon
419 maxconn 256
420
421 defaults
422 mode http
423 timeout connect 5000ms
424 timeout client 50000ms
425 timeout server 50000ms
426
427 listen http-in
428 bind *:80
429 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
430
431
432Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
433
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100434 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200435
436
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004373. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200438--------------------
439
440Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
441are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
442of them have command-line equivalents.
443
444The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
445
446 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200447 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200448 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200449 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200450 - daemon
451 - gid
452 - group
453 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100454 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200455 - nbproc
456 - pidfile
457 - uid
458 - ulimit-n
459 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200460 - stats
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100461 - ssl-server-verify
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200462 - node
463 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100464 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100465
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200466 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200467 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200468 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200469 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100470 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100471 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100472 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200473 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200474 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200475 - maxsslrate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200476 - noepoll
477 - nokqueue
478 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100479 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300480 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200481 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200482 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200483 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100484 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100485 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200486 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100487 - tune.idletimer
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100488 - tune.maxaccept
489 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200490 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200491 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100492 - tune.rcvbuf.client
493 - tune.rcvbuf.server
494 - tune.sndbuf.client
495 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100496 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100497 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200498 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100499 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100500 - tune.zlib.memlevel
501 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100502
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200503 * Debugging
504 - debug
505 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200506
507
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005083.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200509------------------------------------
510
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200511ca-base <dir>
512 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200513 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
514 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200515
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200516chroot <jail dir>
517 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
518 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
519 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
520 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
521 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
522 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100523
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100524cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
525 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
526 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
527 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100528 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
529 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
530 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
531 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
532 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
533 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
534 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
535 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
536 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
537 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100538
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200539crt-base <dir>
540 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
541 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
542 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
543
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200544daemon
545 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
546 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
547 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
548
549gid <number>
550 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
551 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
552 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100553 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
554 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200555 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100556
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200557group <group name>
558 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
559 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100560
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200561log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200562 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
563 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100564 configured with "log global".
565
566 <address> can be one of:
567
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100568 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100569 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
570 port).
571
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100572 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
573 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
574 port).
575
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100576 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
577 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
578 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
579 writeable).
580
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100581 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
582 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and
583 optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done
584 in Bourne shell.
585
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100586 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200587
588 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
589 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
590 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
591
592 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200593 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
594 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
595 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
596 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
597 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
598 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200599
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200600 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200601
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100602log-send-hostname [<string>]
603 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
604 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
605 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
606 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
607 the logs.
608
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000609log-tag <string>
610 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
611 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
612 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
613 running on the same host.
614
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200615nbproc <number>
616 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
617 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
618 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
619 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
620 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
621
622pidfile <pidfile>
623 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
624 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
625 starting the process. See also "daemon".
626
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100627stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200628 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
629 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
630 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
631 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
632 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
633 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100634 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200635 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
636 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200637
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100638ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
639 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
640 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300641 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100642 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
643 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
644 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
645 "bind" keyword for more information.
646
647ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
648 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
649 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300650 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100651 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
652 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
653 information.
654
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100655ssl-server-verify [none|required]
656 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
657 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
658 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
659
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200660stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
661 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
662 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
663 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
664 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200665
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200666 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
667 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
668 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200669
670stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
671 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
672 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100673 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200674
675stats maxconn <connections>
676 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
677 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
678
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200679uid <number>
680 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
681 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
682 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
683 one. See also "gid" and "user".
684
685ulimit-n <number>
686 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
687 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
688 option.
689
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100690unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
691 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
692
693 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
694 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
695 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
696 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
697 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
698 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
699 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
700 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
701 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
702 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
703
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200704user <user name>
705 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
706 See also "uid" and "group".
707
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200708node <name>
709 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
710
711 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
712 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
713 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
714 traffic.
715
716description <text>
717 Add a text that describes the instance.
718
719 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
720 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
721 "<" and ">" characters.
722
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200723
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007243.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200725-----------------------
726
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200727max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
728 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
729 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
730 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
731 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
732 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
733 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
734 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
735 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
736
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200737maxconn <number>
738 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
739 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
740 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
741 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
742
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200743maxconnrate <number>
744 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
745 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
746 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
747 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
748 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
749 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
750 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
751 fairness.
752
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100753maxcomprate <number>
754 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300755 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100756 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
757 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
758 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
759 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
760 default value.
761
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100762maxcompcpuusage <number>
763 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
764 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
765 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
766 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
767 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
768 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
769 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
770 process down and from introducing high latencies.
771
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100772maxpipes <number>
773 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
774 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
775 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
776 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
777 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
778 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
779
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200780maxsessrate <number>
781 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
782 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
783 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
784 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
785 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
786 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
787 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
788 fairness.
789
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200790maxsslconn <number>
791 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
792 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
793 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
794 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
795 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
796 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
797 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
798
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200799maxsslrate <number>
800 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
801 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
802 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
803 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
804 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
805 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
806 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
807 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
808 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
809 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
810
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100811maxzlibmem <number>
812 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
813 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
814 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +0100815 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
816 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
817 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
818
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200819noepoll
820 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
821 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100822 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200823
824nokqueue
825 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
826 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
827 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
828
829nopoll
830 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
831 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100832 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100833 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200834
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100835nosplice
836 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
837 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
838 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100839 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100840 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
841 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
842 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
843 "option splice-response".
844
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300845nogetaddrinfo
846 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
847 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
848
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200849spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +0900850 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
851 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
852 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
853 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
854 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
855 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200856
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200857tune.bufsize <number>
858 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
859 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
860 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
861 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
862 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
863 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
864 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
865 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +0400866 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
867 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
868 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200869
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200870tune.chksize <number>
871 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
872 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
873 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
874 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
875 checks whenever possible.
876
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100877tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
878 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
879 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
880 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
881 this value. The default value is 1.
882
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100883tune.http.cookielen <number>
884 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
885 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
886 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
887 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
888 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
889 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
890 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
891 to change this value.
892
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200893tune.http.maxhdr <number>
894 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
895 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
896 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
897 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
898 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
899 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
900 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
901 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
902 limit too high.
903
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100904tune.idletimer <timeout>
905 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
906 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
907 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
908 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
909 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
910 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
911 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
912 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
913 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
914
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100915tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +0100916 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
917 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
918 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
919 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
920 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
921 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
922 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
923 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
924 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
925 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100926
927tune.maxpollevents <number>
928 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
929 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
930 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
931 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
932 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
933
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200934tune.maxrewrite <number>
935 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
936 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
937 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
938 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
939 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
940 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
941 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
942 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
943 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
944 bufsize.
945
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200946tune.pipesize <number>
947 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
948 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
949 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
950 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
951 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
952 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
953
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100954tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
955tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
956 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
957 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
958 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
959 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
960 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
961 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
962 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
963
964tune.sndbuf.client <number>
965tune.sndbuf.server <number>
966 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
967 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
968 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
969 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
970 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
971 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
972 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
973 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
974 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
975 notifying haproxy again.
976
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100977tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +0100978 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
979 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
980 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300981 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +0100982 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
983 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
984 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
985 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
986 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +0100987 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
988 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100989
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200990tune.ssl.force-private-cache
991 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
992 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
993 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
994 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
995 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
996 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
997
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +0100998tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
999 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001000 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001001 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1002 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1003 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1004 being used for too long.
1005
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001006tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1007 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1008 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1009 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1010 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1011 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1012 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1013 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1014 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1015 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1016 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001017 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1018 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001019
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001020tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1021 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001022 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001023 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1024 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1025 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1026
1027tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1028 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1029 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1030 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1031 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001032
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010333.3. Debugging
1034--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001035
1036debug
1037 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1038 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1039 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1040 system startup.
1041
1042quiet
1043 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1044 line argument "-q".
1045
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001046
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010010473.4. Userlists
1048--------------
1049It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1050http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1051it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1052
1053userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001054 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001055 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1056
1057group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001058 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001059 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1060 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1061
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001062user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1063 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001064 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1065 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001066 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1067 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001068 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001069 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001070
1071
1072 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001073 userlist L1
1074 group G1 users tiger,scott
1075 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001076
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001077 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1078 user scott insecure-password elgato
1079 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001080
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001081 userlist L2
1082 group G1
1083 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001084
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001085 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1086 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1087 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001088
1089 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001090
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001091
10923.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001093----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001094It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
1095haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
1096pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
1097identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
1098or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
1099Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
1100known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
1101the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
1102process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
1103during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
1104tables.
1105
1106peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001107 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001108 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1109
1110peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1111 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1112 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1113 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1114 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1115 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1116 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1117
1118 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1119 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1120
1121 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1122 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1123 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1124 across all peers.
1125
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001126 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
1127 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and optionally
1128 enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
1129
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001130 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001131 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001132 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1133 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1134 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001135
1136 backend mybackend
1137 mode tcp
1138 balance roundrobin
1139 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1140 stick on src
1141
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001142 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1143 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001144
1145
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011464. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001147----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001148
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001149Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
1150 - defaults <name>
1151 - frontend <name>
1152 - backend <name>
1153 - listen <name>
1154
1155A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1156its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1157section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001158section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001159
1160A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1161connections.
1162
1163A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1164to forward incoming connections.
1165
1166A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1167parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1168
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001169All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1170'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1171case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1172
1173Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1174logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1175proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1176However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1177name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1178
1179Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1180and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001181bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001182protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1183modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1184arbitrary criteria.
1185
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001186In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1187a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1188the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1189
1190 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1191 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1192 between responses and new requests.
1193
1194 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1195 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1196 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1197 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1198
1199 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1200 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1201 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1202
1203 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1204 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1205 client-facing connection remains open.
1206
1207 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1208 after the end of the response.
1209
1210The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1211frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1212following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1213weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1214
1215 Backend mode
1216
1217 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1218 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1219 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1220 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1221 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1222 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1223 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1224 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1225 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1226 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1227 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1228
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001229
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001230
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012314.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1232--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001233
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001234The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1235limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1236they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1237limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001238marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001239option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001240and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1241with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1242specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001243
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001244
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001245 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1246------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1247acl - X X X
1248appsession - - X X
1249backlog X X X -
1250balance X - X X
1251bind - X X -
1252bind-process X X X X
1253block - X X X
1254capture cookie - X X -
1255capture request header - X X -
1256capture response header - X X -
1257clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001258compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001259contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1260cookie X - X X
1261default-server X - X X
1262default_backend X X X -
1263description - X X X
1264disabled X X X X
1265dispatch - - X X
1266enabled X X X X
1267errorfile X X X X
1268errorloc X X X X
1269errorloc302 X X X X
1270-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1271errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001272force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001273fullconn X - X X
1274grace X X X X
1275hash-type X - X X
1276http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001277http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001278http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001279http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001280http-response - X X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001281http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001282id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001283ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001284log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001285max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001286maxconn X X X -
1287mode X X X X
1288monitor fail - X X -
1289monitor-net X X X -
1290monitor-uri X X X -
1291option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1292option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1293option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1294option allbackups (*) X - X X
1295option checkcache (*) X - X X
1296option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1297option contstats (*) X X X -
1298option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1299option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1300option forceclose (*) X X X X
1301-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1302option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001303option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001304option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001305option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001306option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001307option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001308option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1309option httpchk X - X X
1310option httpclose (*) X X X X
1311option httplog X X X X
1312option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001313option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001314option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001315option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1316option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1317option logasap (*) X X X -
1318option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001319option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001320option nolinger (*) X X X X
1321option originalto X X X X
1322option persist (*) X - X X
1323option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001324option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001325option smtpchk X - X X
1326option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1327option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1328option splice-request (*) X X X X
1329option splice-response (*) X X X X
1330option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1331option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1332-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001333option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001334option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1335option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1336option tcpka X X X X
1337option tcplog X X X X
1338option transparent (*) X - X X
1339persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1340rate-limit sessions X X X -
1341redirect - X X X
1342redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1343redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1344reqadd - X X X
1345reqallow - X X X
1346reqdel - X X X
1347reqdeny - X X X
1348reqiallow - X X X
1349reqidel - X X X
1350reqideny - X X X
1351reqipass - X X X
1352reqirep - X X X
1353reqisetbe - X X X
1354reqitarpit - X X X
1355reqpass - X X X
1356reqrep - X X X
1357-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1358reqsetbe - X X X
1359reqtarpit - X X X
1360retries X - X X
1361rspadd - X X X
1362rspdel - X X X
1363rspdeny - X X X
1364rspidel - X X X
1365rspideny - X X X
1366rspirep - X X X
1367rsprep - X X X
1368server - - X X
1369source X - X X
1370srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001371stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001372stats auth X - X X
1373stats enable X - X X
1374stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001375stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001376stats realm X - X X
1377stats refresh X - X X
1378stats scope X - X X
1379stats show-desc X - X X
1380stats show-legends X - X X
1381stats show-node X - X X
1382stats uri X - X X
1383-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1384stick match - - X X
1385stick on - - X X
1386stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001387stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001388stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001389tcp-check connect - - X X
1390tcp-check expect - - X X
1391tcp-check send - - X X
1392tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001393tcp-request connection - X X -
1394tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001395tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001396tcp-response content - - X X
1397tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001398timeout check X - X X
1399timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001400timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001401timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1402timeout connect X - X X
1403timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1404timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1405timeout http-request X X X X
1406timeout queue X - X X
1407timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001408timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001409timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1410timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001411timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001412transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001413unique-id-format X X X -
1414unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001415use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001416use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001417------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1418 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001419
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001420
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014214.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1422---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001423
1424This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1425
1426
1427acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1428 Declare or complete an access list.
1429 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1430 no | yes | yes | yes
1431 Example:
1432 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1433 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1434 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1435
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001436 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001437
1438
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001439appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1440 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001441 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1442 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1443 no | no | yes | yes
1444 Arguments :
1445 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1446 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1447
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001448 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001449 checked in each cookie value.
1450
1451 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1452 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1453 milliseconds.
1454
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001455 request-learn
1456 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1457 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1458 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1459 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1460 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1461 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1462
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001463 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1464 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1465 data following this prefix.
1466
1467 Example :
1468 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1469
1470 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1471 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1472
1473 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1474 2 modes are currently supported :
1475 - path-parameters :
1476 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1477 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1478 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1479 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1480 - query-string :
1481 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1482 query string.
1483
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001484 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1485 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1486 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1487 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001488 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1489 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1490 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001491 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1492 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1493
1494 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1495
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001496 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1497 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1498 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1499
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001500 Example :
1501 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1502
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001503 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1504 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001505
1506
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001507backlog <conns>
1508 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1509 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1510 yes | yes | yes | no
1511 Arguments :
1512 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1513 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001514 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001515
1516 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1517 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1518 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1519 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1520 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1521 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1522 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1523 backlog parameter.
1524
1525 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1526 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1527 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1528
1529 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1530
1531
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001532balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001533balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001534 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1535 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1536 yes | no | yes | yes
1537 Arguments :
1538 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1539 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1540 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1541 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1542
1543 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1544 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1545 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1546 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001547 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08001548 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001549 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1550 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1551 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1552 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1553 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1554 it, so that you don't worry.
1555
1556 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1557 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1558 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1559 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1560 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1561 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1562 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1563 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001564
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001565 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1566 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1567 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1568 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1569 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1570 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1571 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1572 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1573
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001574 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001575 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001576 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1577 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001578 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001579 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1580 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1581 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1582 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1583 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001584 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1585 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1586 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1587 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1588 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1589 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001590
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001591 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1592 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1593 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1594 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1595 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1596 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1597 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1598 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001599 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001600 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001601 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1602 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1603 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001604
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001605 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1606 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1607 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1608 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1609 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1610 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1611 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1612 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1613 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1614 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1615 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1616 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001617
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001618 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001619 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1620 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1621 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1622 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1623 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1624 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1625 URIs start with a leading "/".
1626
1627 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1628 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1629 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1630 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1631
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001632 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001633 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1634
1635 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001636 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1637 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001638 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
1639 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
1640 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
1641 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001642 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001643 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
1644 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001645
1646 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1647 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1648 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1649 server will receive the request.
1650
1651 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1652 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1653 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1654 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1655 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001656 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1657 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1658 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001659
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001660 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1661 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1662 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1663 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1664 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001665
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001666 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001667 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1668 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1669 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1670
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001671 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1672 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1673 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1674
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001675 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001676 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001677 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1678 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1679 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1680 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1681 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1682 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001683 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001684 used instead.
1685
1686 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1687 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1688 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1689 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1690
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001691 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1692 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1693 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1694
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001695 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001696
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001697 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001698 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1699 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001700
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001701 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1702 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1703 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001704
1705 Examples :
1706 balance roundrobin
1707 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001708 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001709 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1710 balance hdr(host)
1711 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001712
1713 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1714 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1715
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001716 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001717 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1718 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1719 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1720 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1721
1722 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1723 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1724 defaults to 16 kB.
1725
1726 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1727 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1728
1729 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1730 Round Robin.
1731
1732 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1733 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1734 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1735 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1736
1737 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1738
1739 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001740 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001741 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1742 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1743 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001744
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001745 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1746 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001747
1748
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001749bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1750bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001751 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1752 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1753 no | yes | yes | no
1754 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001755 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1756 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1757 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1758 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001759 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001760 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
1761 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
1762 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
1763 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
1764 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
1765 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
1766 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02001767 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01001768 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
1769 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
1770 be listening.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001771 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
1772 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
1773 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
1774 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001775
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001776 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1777 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001778 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1779 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1780 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001781 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1782 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1783 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1784 the range.
1785
1786 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1787 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1788 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1789 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1790 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1791 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1792 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001793 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001794 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001795
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001796 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1797 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1798 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1799 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1800 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1801 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1802 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1803 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1804
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001805 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1806 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1807 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1808 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001809
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001810 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1811 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1812 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1813 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1814 in a frontend.
1815
1816 Example :
1817 listen http_proxy
1818 bind :80,:443
1819 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001820 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001821
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001822 listen http_https_proxy
1823 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02001824 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001825
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001826 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
1827 bind ipv6@:80
1828 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
1829 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
1830
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001831 listen external_bind_app1
1832 bind fd@${FD_APP1}
1833
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001834 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001835 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001836
1837
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001838bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001839 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1840 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1841 yes | yes | yes | yes
1842 Arguments :
1843 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1844 may be used to override a default value.
1845
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001846 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001847 option may be combined with other numbers.
1848
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001849 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001850 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1851 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1852 missing from all processes.
1853
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001854 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001855 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02001856 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
1857 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
1858 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
1859 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001860
1861 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1862 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1863 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1864 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1865 and 'even' instances.
1866
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001867 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
1868 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
1869 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
1870 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001871
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02001872 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
1873 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
1874
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001875 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1876 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1877
1878 Example :
1879 listen app_ip1
1880 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001881 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001882
1883 listen app_ip2
1884 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001885 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001886
1887 listen management
1888 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001889 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001890
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001891 listen management
1892 bind 10.0.0.4:80
1893 bind-process 1-4
1894
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02001895 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001896
1897
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001898block { if | unless } <condition>
1899 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1900 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1901 no | yes | yes | yes
1902
1903 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1904 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001905 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001906 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001907 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1908 "block" statements per instance.
1909
1910 Example:
1911 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1912 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1913 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1914 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1915
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001916 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001917
1918
1919capture cookie <name> len <length>
1920 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1921 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1922 no | yes | yes | no
1923 Arguments :
1924 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1925 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1926 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1927 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1928 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1929
1930 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1931 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1932 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1933 right if it exceeds <length>.
1934
1935 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1936 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1937 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1938 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1939
1940 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1941 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1942 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1943
1944 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1945 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1946 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001947 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
1948 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
1949 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001950
1951 Example:
1952 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1953
1954 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001955 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001956
1957
1958capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001959 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001960 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1961 no | yes | yes | no
1962 Arguments :
1963 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001964 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001965 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1966 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1967 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1968
1969 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1970 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1971 it exceeds <length>.
1972
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001973 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001974 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1975 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001976 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1977 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1978 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1979 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001980 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001981 environments to find where the request came from.
1982
1983 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1984 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1985 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1986 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001987
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01001988 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
1989 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
1990 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
1991 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
1992 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001993
1994 Example:
1995 capture request header Host len 15
1996 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1997 capture request header Referrer len 15
1998
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001999 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002000 about logging.
2001
2002
2003capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002004 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002005 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2006 no | yes | yes | no
2007 Arguments :
2008 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002009 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002010 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2011 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2012 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2013
2014 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2015 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2016 it exceeds <length>.
2017
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002018 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002019 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2020 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2021 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002022 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2023 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2024 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2025 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002026
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002027 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2028 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2029 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2030 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2031 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002032
2033 Example:
2034 capture response header Content-length len 9
2035 capture response header Location len 15
2036
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002037 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002038 about logging.
2039
2040
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002041clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002042 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2043 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2044 yes | yes | yes | no
2045 Arguments :
2046 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2047 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2048 as explained at the top of this document.
2049
2050 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2051 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2052 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2053 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2054 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2055 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2056 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2057 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002058 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002059 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2060 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2061
2062 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2063 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2064 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2065 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2066 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2067 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2068
2069 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2070 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2071
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002072 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2073 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002074
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002075compression algo <algorithm> ...
2076compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002077compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002078 Enable HTTP compression.
2079 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2080 yes | yes | yes | yes
2081 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002082 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2083 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2084 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2085
2086 The currently supported algorithms are :
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002087 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002088 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2089 data.
2090
2091 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
2092 support for zlib was built in.
2093
2094 deflate same as gzip, but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2095 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many browsers
2096 and no support at all from recent ones. It is strongly
2097 recommended not to use it for anything else than experimentation.
2098 This setting is only available when support for zlib was built
2099 in.
2100
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002101 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002102 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002103 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2104 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2105 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2106 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2107 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002108
2109 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2110 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2111 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2112 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2113 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002114 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2115 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2116 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2117 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2118 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
2119 then be used for such scenarios.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002120
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002121 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002122 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2123 "Accept-Encoding" header
2124 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002125 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002126 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2127 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002128 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2129 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2130 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2131 "multipart"
2132 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2133 header
2134 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2135 and later
2136 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2137 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002138
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002139 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2140 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002141
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002142 Examples :
2143 compression algo gzip
2144 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002145
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002146contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002147 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2148 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2149 yes | no | yes | yes
2150 Arguments :
2151 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2152 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2153 as explained at the top of this document.
2154
2155 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002156 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002157 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002158 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2159 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2160 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2161 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2162
2163 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2164 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2165 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2166 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2167 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2168 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2169
2170 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2171 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2172 instead.
2173
2174 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2175 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2176
2177
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002178cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002179 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2180 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002181 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2182 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2183 yes | no | yes | yes
2184 Arguments :
2185 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2186 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2187 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2188 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2189 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2190 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2191 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2192 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2193 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2194
2195 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2196 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2197 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2198 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2199 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2200 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2201 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2202 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2203 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2204 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2205 "insert" and "prefix".
2206
2207 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002208 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002209
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002210 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002211 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2212 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2213 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2214 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2215 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2216 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2217 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2218 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2219 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2220 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002221
2222 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2223 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2224 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2225 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2226 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2227 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2228 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2229 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2230 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2231 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002232 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2233 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2234 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002235
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002236 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2237 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2238 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002239 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2240 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2241 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2242 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002243 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2244 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2245 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002246
2247 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2248 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2249 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2250 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2251 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2252 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2253 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2254 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2255 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2256
2257 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2258 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2259 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2260 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2261 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2262 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2263 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2264 persistence cookie in the cache.
2265 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2266
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002267 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2268 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2269 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2270 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2271 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2272 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2273 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2274 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2275 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2276 they logout.
2277
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002278 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2279 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2280 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2281 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2282
2283 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2284 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2285 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2286 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2287 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2288 this attribute.
2289
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002290 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002291 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002292 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2293 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2294 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2295 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2296 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2297 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002298
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002299 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2300 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2301 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2302 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2303 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2304 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2305 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2306 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2307 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2308 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2309 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2310 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2311 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2312 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2313 the site.
2314
2315 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2316 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2317 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2318 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2319 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2320 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2321 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2322 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2323 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2324 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2325 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2326 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2327 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2328 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2329 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2330 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2331
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002332 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2333 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2334 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2335 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002336
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002337 Examples :
2338 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2339 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2340 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002341 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002342
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002343 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002344 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002345
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002346
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002347default-server [param*]
2348 Change default options for a server in a backend
2349 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2350 yes | no | yes | yes
2351 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002352 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2353 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2354 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2355 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002356
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002357 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002358 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2359
2360 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002361
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002362
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002363default_backend <backend>
2364 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2365 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2366 yes | yes | yes | no
2367 Arguments :
2368 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2369
2370 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2371 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2372 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2373 will catch all undetermined requests.
2374
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002375 Example :
2376
2377 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2378 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2379 default_backend dynamic
2380
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002381 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2382
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002383
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002384description <string>
2385 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2386 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2387 no | yes | yes | yes
2388 Arguments : string
2389
2390 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2391 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2392 it describes.
2393 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2394
2395
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002396disabled
2397 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2398 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2399 yes | yes | yes | yes
2400 Arguments : none
2401
2402 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2403 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2404 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2405 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2406 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2407 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2408 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2409
2410 See also : "enabled"
2411
2412
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002413dispatch <address>:<port>
2414 Set a default server address
2415 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2416 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002417 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002418
2419 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2420 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2421 during start-up.
2422
2423 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2424 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2425 possible with normal servers.
2426
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002427 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002428 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2429 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2430 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2431 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2432
2433 See also : "server"
2434
2435
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002436enabled
2437 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2438 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2439 yes | yes | yes | yes
2440 Arguments : none
2441
2442 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2443 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2444
2445 See also : "disabled"
2446
2447
2448errorfile <code> <file>
2449 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2450 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2451 yes | yes | yes | yes
2452 Arguments :
2453 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002454 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002455
2456 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002457 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002458 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002459 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2460 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002461
2462 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2463 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2464 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2465
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002466 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2467
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002468 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2469 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2470 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2471 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2472
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002473 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2474 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2475 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2476 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2477 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2478 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2479
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002480 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2481 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2482 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002483 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002484 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2485
2486 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2487
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002488 Example :
2489 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02002490 errorfile 408 /dev/null # workaround Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002491 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2492 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2493
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002494
2495errorloc <code> <url>
2496errorloc302 <code> <url>
2497 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2498 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2499 yes | yes | yes | yes
2500 Arguments :
2501 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002502 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002503
2504 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2505 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2506 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2507 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2508 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2509
2510 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2511 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2512 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2513
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002514 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2515
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002516 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2517 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2518 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2519 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2520 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2521 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2522 request.
2523
2524 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2525
2526
2527errorloc303 <code> <url>
2528 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2529 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2530 yes | yes | yes | yes
2531 Arguments :
2532 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2533 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2534
2535 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2536 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2537 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2538 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2539 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2540
2541 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2542 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2543 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2544
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002545 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2546
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002547 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2548 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2549 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2550 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002551 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002552
2553 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2554
2555
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002556force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2557 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2558 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2559 no | yes | yes | yes
2560
2561 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2562 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2563 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2564 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2565 marked down for maintenance operations.
2566
2567 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2568 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2569 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2570 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2571 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2572 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2573 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2574 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2575 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2576
2577 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2578 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2579 is used.
2580
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002581 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002582 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002583
2584
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002585fullconn <conns>
2586 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2587 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2588 yes | no | yes | yes
2589 Arguments :
2590 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2591 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2592
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002593 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002594 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002595 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002596 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2597 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2598 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2599 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2600 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002601 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002602
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002603 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2604 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01002605 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
2606 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
2607 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002608
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002609 Example :
2610 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2611 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2612 # connections.
2613 backend dynamic
2614 fullconn 10000
2615 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2616 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2617
2618 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2619
2620
2621grace <time>
2622 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2623 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002624 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002625 Arguments :
2626 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2627 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2628 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2629
2630 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2631 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002632 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002633 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2634
2635 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2636 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2637 simplify it.
2638
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002639
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002640hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002641 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2642 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2643 yes | no | yes | yes
2644 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002645 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
2646 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002647
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002648 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2649 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
2650 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
2651 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
2652 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
2653 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
2654 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
2655 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
2656 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
2657 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002658
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002659 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2660 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2661 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2662 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2663 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2664 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
2665 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
2666 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
2667 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
2668 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
2669 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
2670 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
2671 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002672 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
2673 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002674
2675 <function> is the hash function to be used :
2676
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002677 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002678 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
2679 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
2680 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002681 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
2682 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
2683 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002684
2685 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
2686 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002687 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
2688 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
2689 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
2690 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
2691
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01002692 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
2693 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
2694 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
2695 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
2696 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
2697 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
2698 parameter.
2699
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002700 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
2701
2702 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
2703 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
2704 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
2705 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
2706 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
2707 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
2708 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
2709 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
2710 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
2711 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
2712 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
2713 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002714
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002715 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
2716 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
2717 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002718
2719 See also : "balance", "server"
2720
2721
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002722http-check disable-on-404
2723 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2724 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002725 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002726 Arguments : none
2727
2728 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2729 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2730 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2731 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2732 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2733 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2734 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2735 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002736 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2737 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2738 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2739
2740 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2741
2742
2743http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002744 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002745 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002746 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002747 Arguments :
2748 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2749 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002750 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002751 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2752 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2753 details on the supported keywords.
2754
2755 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2756 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2757 with the usual backslash ('\').
2758
2759 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2760 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2761 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2762 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2763 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2764
2765 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002766 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002767 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2768 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2769 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2770
2771 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002772 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002773 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2774 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2775 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2776 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2777
2778 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002779 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002780 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2781 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2782 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2783 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2784 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2785 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2786 trace).
2787
2788 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002789 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002790 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2791 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2792 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2793 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2794 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2795 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2796
2797 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2798 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2799 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2800 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2801 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2802 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2803 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2804 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2805
2806 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2807 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2808
2809 Examples :
2810 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002811 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002812
2813 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002814 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002815
2816 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002817 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002818
2819 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002820 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002821
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002822 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002823
2824
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002825http-check send-state
2826 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2827 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2828 yes | no | yes | yes
2829 Arguments : none
2830
2831 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2832 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2833 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2834 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2835 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2836
2837 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2838 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2839 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2840 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2841 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2842 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2843 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2844 checked in multiple backends.
2845
2846 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2847 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2848
2849 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2850 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2851 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2852 one fails.
2853
2854 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2855 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2856 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2857
2858 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2859 server's queue.
2860
2861 Example of a header received by the application server :
2862 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2863 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2864
2865 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2866
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002867http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002868 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02002869 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02002870 set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
2871 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2872 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2873 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2874 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
2875 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002876 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002877 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2878
2879 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2880 no | yes | yes | yes
2881
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002882 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2883 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2884 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2885 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2886 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002887
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002888 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2889 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
2890 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
2891
2892 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
2893 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
2894 are evaluated.
2895
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002896 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
2897 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
2898 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
2899 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
2900 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
2901 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
2902 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
2903 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
2904 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002905 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002906 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
2907
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002908 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
2909 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
2910 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
2911 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
2912 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
2913
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002914 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
2915 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
2916 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01002917 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
2918 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002919
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002920 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
2921 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
2922 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
2923 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
2924 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
2925 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
2926 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
2927 the resulting header from a previous rule.
2928
2929 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
2930 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
2931 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
2932 external users.
2933
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02002934 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
2935 <name>.
2936
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002937 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
2938 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
2939 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
2940 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
2941 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
2942 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
2943 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
2944 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
2945
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02002946 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
2947 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
2948 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
2949 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
2950 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
2951 another equipment.
2952
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02002953 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
2954 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
2955 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
2956 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
2957 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
2958 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
2959 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
2960 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
2961
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02002962 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
2963 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
2964 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
2965 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
2966 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
2967 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
2968 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
2969 admin privileges.
2970
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02002971 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
2972 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
2973 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
2974 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
2975 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
2976 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
2977 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
2978 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
2979
2980 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
2981 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
2982 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
2983 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
2984 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
2985 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
2986
2987 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
2988 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
2989 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
2990 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
2991 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
2992 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
2993
2994 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
2995 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
2996 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
2997 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
2998 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
2999 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3000 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3001 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3002 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3003
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003004 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
3005
3006 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
3007 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
3008 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
3009 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003010
3011 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003012 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
3013 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
3014 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003015
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003016 http-request allow if nagios
3017 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
3018 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
3019 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003020
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003021 Example:
3022 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003023 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003024
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003025 Example:
3026 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
3027 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
3028 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id]
3029 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
3030 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
3031 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
3032 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
3033 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
3034 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
3035
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003036 Example:
3037 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
3038 acl add path /addacl
3039 acl del path /delacl
3040
3041 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3042
3043 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
3044 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
3045
3046 Example:
3047 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3048 acl setmap path /setmap
3049 acl delmap path /delmap
3050
3051 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3052
3053 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
3054 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
3055
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02003056 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
3057 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003058
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003059http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003060 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003061 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
3062 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3063 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3064 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3065 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
3066 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02003067 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003068 Access control for Layer 7 responses
3069
3070 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3071 no | yes | yes | yes
3072
3073 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3074 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3075 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3076 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3077 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
3078 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
3079
3080 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3081 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
3082 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
3083 current section.
3084
3085 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3086 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
3087 rules are evaluated.
3088
3089 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3090 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3091 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
3092 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
3093 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
3094 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
3095 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
3096
3097 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3098 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3099 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
3100 external users.
3101
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003102 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3103 <name>.
3104
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003105 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3106 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3107 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3108 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3109 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3110 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3111 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3112 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3113
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003114 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3115 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3116 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3117 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3118 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3119 another equipment.
3120
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003121 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3122 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3123 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3124 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3125 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3126 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3127 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3128 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3129
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003130 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3131 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3132 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3133 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3134 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3135 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3136 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3137 admin privileges.
3138
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003139 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3140 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3141 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3142 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3143 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3144 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3145 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3146 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3147
3148 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3149 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3150 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3151 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3152 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3153 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3154
3155 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3156 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3157 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3158 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3159 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3160 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3161
3162 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3163 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3164 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3165 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3166 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3167 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3168 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3169 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3170 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3171
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003172 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
3173
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08003174 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003175 the HTTP processing, before "reqdel" or "reqrep" rules. That way, headers
3176 added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
3177 rules.
3178
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003179 Example:
3180 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
3181
3182 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3183
3184 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3185 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3186
3187 Example:
3188 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3189
3190 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3191
3192 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
3193 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
3194
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003195 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
3196 ACL usage.
3197
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003198
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05003199http-send-name-header [<header>]
3200 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
3201
3202 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3203 yes | no | yes | yes
3204
3205 Arguments :
3206
3207 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
3208
3209 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
3210 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
3211 is added with the header string proved.
3212
3213 See also : "server"
3214
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003215id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02003216 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
3217 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3218 no | yes | yes | yes
3219 Arguments : none
3220
3221 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
3222 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
3223 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003224
3225
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003226ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3227 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
3228 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3229 no | yes | yes | yes
3230
3231 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
3232 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
3233 and running).
3234
3235 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3236 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
3237 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003238 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003239 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
3240
3241 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
3242 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
3243
3244 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3245 "unless" condition is met.
3246
3247 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
3248
3249
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003250log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003251log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003252no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003253 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
3254 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3255 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003256
3257 Prefix :
3258 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
3259 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
3260 prefix does not allow arguments.
3261
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003262 Arguments :
3263 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
3264 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
3265 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
3266 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
3267 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
3268 parameter.
3269
3270 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
3271 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
3272
3273 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
3274 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3275 standard syslog port).
3276
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01003277 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
3278 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3279 standard syslog port).
3280
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003281 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
3282 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
3283 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
3284 appropriately writeable).
3285
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003286 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
3287 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
3288 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
3289 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
3290
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003291 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
3292
3293 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
3294 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
3295 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
3296
3297 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
3298 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
3299 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003300 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
3301 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
3302 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
3303 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
3304 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003305
3306 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3307
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003308 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
3309 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
3310 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003311
3312 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
3313 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
3314 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
3315 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
3316
3317 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
3318 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003319
3320 Example :
3321 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003322 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
3323 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003324 log ${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514 local0 notice # send to local server
3325
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003326
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003327log-format <string>
3328 Allows you to custom a log line.
3329
3330 See also : Custom Log Format (8.2.4)
3331
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003332
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003333max-keep-alive-queue <value>
3334 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
3335 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3336 yes | no | yes | yes
3337
3338 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
3339 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
3340 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
3341 servers.
3342
3343 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
3344 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
3345 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
3346 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
3347 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
3348 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
3349 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
3350 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
3351 picking a different server.
3352
3353 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
3354 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
3355 even if they have to be queued.
3356
3357 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
3358 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
3359
3360
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003361maxconn <conns>
3362 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
3363 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3364 yes | yes | yes | no
3365 Arguments :
3366 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
3367 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
3368 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
3369 closes.
3370
3371 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
3372 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
3373 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
3374 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
3375 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
3376 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
3377 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
3378 properly tuned.
3379
3380 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
3381 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
3382 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
3383
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02003384 By default, this value is set to 2000.
3385
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003386 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
3387
3388
3389mode { tcp|http|health }
3390 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
3391 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3392 yes | yes | yes | yes
3393 Arguments :
3394 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
3395 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
3396 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
3397 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
3398
3399 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
3400 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
3401 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
3402 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
3403 brings HAProxy most of its value.
3404
3405 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003406 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
3407 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
3408 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
3409 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
3410 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
3411 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
3412 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003413
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003414 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
3415 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
3416 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003417
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003418 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003419 defaults http_instances
3420 mode http
3421
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003422 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003423
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003424
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003425monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003426 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003427 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3428 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003429 Arguments :
3430 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
3431 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003432 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003433 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
3434 backend and its backup.
3435
3436 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
3437 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
3438 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
3439 servers in a list of backends.
3440
3441 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
3442 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
3443 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
3444 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
3445 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
3446 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
3447 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003448 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
3449 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003450
3451 Example:
3452 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003453 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003454 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
3455 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
3456 monitor-uri /site_alive
3457 monitor fail if site_dead
3458
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003459 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003460
3461
3462monitor-net <source>
3463 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
3464 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3465 yes | yes | yes | no
3466 Arguments :
3467 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
3468 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
3469 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
3470 followed by a mask.
3471
3472 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
3473 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003474 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003475 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
3476
3477 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
3478 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
3479 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
3480 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003481 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
3482 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
3483 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003484
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003485 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
3486 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
3487 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
3488 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
3489 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
3490 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003491
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01003492 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
3493 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003494
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003495 Example :
3496 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
3497 frontend www
3498 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
3499
3500 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
3501
3502
3503monitor-uri <uri>
3504 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
3505 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3506 yes | yes | yes | no
3507 Arguments :
3508 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
3509 health status instead of forwarding the request.
3510
3511 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
3512 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
3513 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
3514 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
3515 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
3516 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
3517 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
3518 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
3519
3520 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
3521 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
3522 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
3523 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
3524 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
3525 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
3526
3527 Example :
3528 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
3529 frontend www
3530 mode http
3531 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
3532
3533 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
3534
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003535
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003536option abortonclose
3537no option abortonclose
3538 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
3539 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3540 yes | no | yes | yes
3541 Arguments : none
3542
3543 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
3544 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
3545 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
3546 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003547 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003548 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
3549 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
3550 encountered while delivering the response.
3551
3552 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
3553 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
3554 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
3555 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
3556 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
3557 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003558 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003559 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003560 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003561 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
3562 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
3563 still not served and not pollute the servers.
3564
3565 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
3566 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
3567 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
3568 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
3569 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
3570 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
3571 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
3572 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003573 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003574
3575 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3576 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3577
3578 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
3579
3580
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003581option accept-invalid-http-request
3582no option accept-invalid-http-request
3583 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
3584 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3585 yes | yes | yes | no
3586 Arguments : none
3587
3588 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3589 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3590 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3591 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3592 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3593 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3594 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3595 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003596 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
3597 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
3598 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
3599 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
3600 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
3601 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003602
3603 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3604 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3605 been confirmed.
3606
3607 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3608 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003609 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
3610 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003611 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3612
3613 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3614 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3615
3616 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
3617 stats socket.
3618
3619
3620option accept-invalid-http-response
3621no option accept-invalid-http-response
3622 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
3623 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3624 yes | no | yes | yes
3625 Arguments : none
3626
3627 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3628 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3629 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3630 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3631 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3632 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3633 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3634 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
3635 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
3636
3637 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3638 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3639 been confirmed.
3640
3641 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3642 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
3643 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
3644 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3645
3646 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3647 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3648
3649 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
3650 stats socket.
3651
3652
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003653option allbackups
3654no option allbackups
3655 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
3656 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3657 yes | no | yes | yes
3658 Arguments : none
3659
3660 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
3661 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
3662 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
3663 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
3664 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
3665 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
3666 order between the backup servers anymore.
3667
3668 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
3669 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
3670
3671 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3672 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3673
3674
3675option checkcache
3676no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08003677 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003678 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3679 yes | no | yes | yes
3680 Arguments : none
3681
3682 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
3683 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003684 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003685 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
3686 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003687 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003688
3689 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003690 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003691 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003692 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
3693 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003694 to the client are :
3695 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003696 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003697 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003698 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
3699 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
3700 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
3701 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
3702 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
3703 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
3704 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
3705 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
3706 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
3707 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
3708 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
3709
3710 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003711 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003712 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003713 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003714 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3715
3716 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3717 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003718 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003719 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3720
3721 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3722 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3723
3724
3725option clitcpka
3726no option clitcpka
3727 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3728 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3729 yes | yes | yes | no
3730 Arguments : none
3731
3732 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3733 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3734 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3735 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3736
3737 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3738 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3739 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3740 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3741
3742 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3743 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3744 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3745 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3746 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3747
3748 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3749
3750 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3751 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3752 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3753
3754 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3755 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3756
3757 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3758
3759
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003760option contstats
3761 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3762 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3763 yes | yes | yes | no
3764 Arguments : none
3765
3766 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3767 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3768 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3769 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3770 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3771 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3772 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3773
3774
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003775option dontlog-normal
3776no option dontlog-normal
3777 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3778 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3779 yes | yes | yes | no
3780 Arguments : none
3781
3782 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3783 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3784 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3785 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3786 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3787 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3788 logged.
3789
3790 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3791 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3792 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3793
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003794 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003795 logging.
3796
3797
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003798option dontlognull
3799no option dontlognull
3800 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3801 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3802 yes | yes | yes | no
3803 Arguments : none
3804
3805 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3806 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3807 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3808 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3809 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3810 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3811 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3812
3813 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3814 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3815 would not be logged.
3816
3817 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3818 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3819
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003820 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003821
3822
3823option forceclose
3824no option forceclose
3825 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3826 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003827 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003828 Arguments : none
3829
3830 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3831 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3832 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3833 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3834 global session times in the logs.
3835
3836 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003837 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01003838 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003839
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003840 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3841 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3842 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3843
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01003844 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
3845 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01003846
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003847 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3848 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3849
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003850 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003851
3852
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003853option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003854 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3855 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3856 yes | yes | yes | yes
3857 Arguments :
3858 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3859 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003860 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003861 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003862
3863 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3864 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3865 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
3866 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
3867 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
3868 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
3869 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003870 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
3871 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3872 possible that the client has already brought one.
3873
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003874 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003875 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003876 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
3877 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003878 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
3879 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003880
3881 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3882 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3883 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3884 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3885 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3886 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3887 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3888
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003889 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
3890 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
3891 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
3892 are under the control of the end-user.
3893
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003894 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003895 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3896 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003897 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
3898 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
3899 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003900
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003901 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003902 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
3903 frontend www
3904 mode http
3905 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
3906
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003907 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
3908 backend www
3909 mode http
3910 option forwardfor header X-Client
3911
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003912 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003913 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003914
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003915
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003916option http-keep-alive
3917no option http-keep-alive
3918 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
3919 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3920 yes | yes | yes | yes
3921 Arguments : none
3922
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003923 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
3924 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
3925 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
3926 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
3927 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
3928 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
3929 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
3930
3931 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
3932 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003933 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
3934 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
3935 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
3936 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
3937 situations where this option may be useful :
3938
3939 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
3940 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
3941
3942 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
3943 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
3944
3945 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
3946 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
3947 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
3948 request.
3949
3950 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
3951 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01003952 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
3953 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
3954 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003955
3956 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
3957 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
3958
3959 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3960 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3961 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3962 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
3963 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3964 not set.
3965
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01003966 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
3967 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003968 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01003969 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003970
3971 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01003972 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
3973 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003974
3975
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003976option http-no-delay
3977no option http-no-delay
3978 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
3979 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3980 yes | yes | yes | yes
3981 Arguments : none
3982
3983 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
3984 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
3985 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
3986 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
3987 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
3988 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
3989 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
3990 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
3991 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
3992 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
3993 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
3994 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
3995 affected.
3996
3997 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
3998 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
3999 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
4000 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
4001 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
4002 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
4003 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
4004 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
4005 latency environments.
4006
4007
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004008option http-pretend-keepalive
4009no option http-pretend-keepalive
4010 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
4011 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4012 yes | yes | yes | yes
4013 Arguments : none
4014
4015 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
4016 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
4017 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
4018 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
4019 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
4020 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
4021 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
4022 consider the response complete.
4023
4024 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
4025 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
4026 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
4027 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
4028 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
4029 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
4030
4031 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
4032 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
4033 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
4034 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
4035 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
4036 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
4037 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
4038
4039 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4040 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004041 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02004042 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
4043 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004044
4045 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4046 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4047
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004048 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
4049 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004050
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004051
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004052option http-server-close
4053no option http-server-close
4054 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
4055 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4056 yes | yes | yes | yes
4057 Arguments : none
4058
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004059 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4060 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4061 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4062 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4063 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4064 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
4065 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
4066 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
4067 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
4068 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
4069 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
4070 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
4071 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
4072 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
4073 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
4074 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004075
4076 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4077 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4078 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4079 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01004080 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4081 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004082
4083 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4084 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004085 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
4086 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004087 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
4088 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004089
4090 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4091 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4092
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004093 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004094 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4095 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004096
4097
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004098option http-tunnel
4099no option http-tunnel
4100 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
4101 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4102 yes | yes | yes | yes
4103 Arguments : none
4104
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004105 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4106 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4107 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4108 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4109 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4110 "option http-tunnel".
4111
4112 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004113 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004114 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
4115 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
4116 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
4117 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
4118 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
4119 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
4120 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004121
4122 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4123 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4124
4125 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
4126 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4127 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
4128
4129
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004130option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004131no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004132 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
4133 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4134 yes | yes | yes | no
4135 Arguments : none
4136
4137 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
4138 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
4139 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
4140 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
4141 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
4142 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
4143 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
4144
4145 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
4146 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
4147 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
4148 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
4149 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
4150 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
4151 request along its whole life.
4152
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01004153 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
4154 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
4155 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
4156 front of an existing proxy.
4157
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004158 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
4159
4160 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
4161 http-server-close".
4162
4163
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004164option httpchk
4165option httpchk <uri>
4166option httpchk <method> <uri>
4167option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
4168 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
4169 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4170 yes | no | yes | yes
4171 Arguments :
4172 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
4173 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
4174 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
4175 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
4176 ones.
4177
4178 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
4179 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
4180 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
4181
4182 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
4183 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
4184 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
4185 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
4186 after "\r\n" following the version string.
4187
4188 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
4189 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
4190 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
4191 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
4192 the lack of any response.
4193
4194 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
4195
4196 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
4197 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
4198 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
4199
4200 Examples :
4201 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
4202 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
4203 backend https_relay
4204 mode tcp
4205 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
4206 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
4207
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09004208 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
4209 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
4210 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004211
4212
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004213option httpclose
4214no option httpclose
4215 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
4216 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4217 yes | yes | yes | yes
4218 Arguments : none
4219
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004220 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4221 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4222 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4223 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004224 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004225 "option http-tunnel".
4226
4227 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
4228 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
4229 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
4230 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
4231 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
4232 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
4233 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
4234 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004235
4236 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004237 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01004238 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
4239 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
4240 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
4241 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
4242 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004243
4244 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4245 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004246 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
4247 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004248 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
4249 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004250
4251 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4252 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4253
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004254 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
4255 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004256
4257
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004258option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004259 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
4260 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4261 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004262 Arguments :
4263 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
4264 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
4265 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
4266 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
4267 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004268
4269 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4270 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4271 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
4272 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
4273 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
4274 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
4275 ports.
4276
4277 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4278
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004279 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4280 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
4281 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
4282 by default.
4283
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004284 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004285
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004286
4287option http_proxy
4288no option http_proxy
4289 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
4290 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4291 yes | yes | yes | yes
4292 Arguments : none
4293
4294 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
4295 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
4296 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
4297 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
4298 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
4299
4300 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
4301 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
4302 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
4303 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01004304 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004305 be analyzed.
4306
4307 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4308 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4309
4310 Example :
4311 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
4312 backend direct_forward
4313 option httpclose
4314 option http_proxy
4315
4316 See also : "option httpclose"
4317
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004318
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004319option independent-streams
4320no option independent-streams
4321 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004322 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4323 yes | yes | yes | yes
4324 Arguments : none
4325
4326 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
4327 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
4328 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
4329 receive data or not.
4330
4331 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
4332 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
4333 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
4334 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
4335 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
4336 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
4337 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
4338 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
4339 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
4340 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
4341 socket buffers.
4342
4343 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
4344 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
4345 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
4346 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
4347 slow lines, so use it with caution.
4348
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004349 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004350 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
4351 deprecated.
4352
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02004353 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004354
4355
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02004356option ldap-check
4357 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
4358 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4359 yes | no | yes | yes
4360 Arguments : none
4361
4362 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
4363 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
4364 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
4365 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
4366
4367 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
4368 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
4369
4370 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
4371 configure it.
4372
4373 Example :
4374 option ldap-check
4375
4376 See also : "option httpchk"
4377
4378
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004379option log-health-checks
4380no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004381 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004382 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4383 yes | no | yes | yes
4384 Arguments : none
4385
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004386 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
4387 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
4388 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004389
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004390 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
4391 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
4392 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
4393 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
4394 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
4395
4396 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
4397 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004398
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004399 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
4400 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
4401 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004402
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004403
4404option log-separate-errors
4405no option log-separate-errors
4406 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
4407 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4408 yes | yes | yes | no
4409 Arguments : none
4410
4411 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
4412 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
4413 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
4414 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
4415 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
4416 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
4417 provides very important information.
4418
4419 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
4420 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
4421 error logs.
4422
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004423 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004424 logging.
4425
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004426
4427option logasap
4428no option logasap
4429 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
4430 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4431 yes | yes | yes | no
4432 Arguments : none
4433
4434 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
4435 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
4436 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
4437 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
4438 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
4439 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
4440 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004441 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004442 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
4443 bytes are expected to be transferred.
4444
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004445 Examples :
4446 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
4447 mode http
4448 option httplog
4449 option logasap
4450 log 192.168.2.200 local3
4451
4452 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
4453 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
4454 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
4455 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
4456
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004457 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004458 logging.
4459
4460
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004461option mysql-check [ user <username> ]
4462 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004463 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4464 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004465 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004466 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
4467 server.
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004468
4469 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
4470 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
4471 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
4472 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
4473 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
4474 in the MySQL table, like this :
4475
4476 USE mysql;
4477 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
4478 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
4479
4480 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
4481 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
4482 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
4483 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
4484 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
4485 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
4486 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
4487 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
4488 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
4489
4490 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
4491 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004492
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02004493 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004494
4495 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
4496 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
4497 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4498 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4499 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
4500 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
4501
4502 See also: "option httpchk"
4503
4504
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004505option nolinger
4506no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004507 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004508 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4509 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004510 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004511
4512 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
4513 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
4514 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
4515 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
4516 connections.
4517
4518 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
4519 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
4520 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
4521 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
4522 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
4523 this too.
4524
4525 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
4526 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
4527 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
4528
4529 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
4530 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
4531 for servers.
4532
4533 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4534 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4535
4536
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004537option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
4538 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
4539 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4540 yes | yes | yes | yes
4541 Arguments :
4542 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4543 matching <network>
4544 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
4545 header name.
4546
4547 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
4548 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
4549 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
4550 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
4551 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
4552 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
4553 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
4554 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
4555 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4556 possible that the client has already brought one.
4557
4558 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
4559 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
4560 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
4561 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
4562 header and requires different one.
4563
4564 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4565 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4566 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4567 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4568 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4569 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4570 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4571
4572 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
4573 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4574 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
4575 both are defined.
4576
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004577 Examples :
4578 # Original Destination address
4579 frontend www
4580 mode http
4581 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
4582
4583 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
4584 backend www
4585 mode http
4586 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
4587
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004588 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
4589 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004590
4591
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004592option persist
4593no option persist
4594 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
4595 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4596 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004597 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004598
4599 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
4600 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
4601 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
4602 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
4603 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
4604 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
4605 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
4606 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
4607 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
4608 redirected to another valid server.
4609
4610 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4611 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4612
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004613 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004614
4615
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01004616option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
4617 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
4618 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4619 yes | no | yes | yes
4620 Arguments :
4621 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
4622 PostgreSQL server.
4623
4624 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
4625 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
4626 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
4627 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
4628
4629 See also: "option httpchk"
4630
4631
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004632option prefer-last-server
4633no option prefer-last-server
4634 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
4635 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4636 yes | no | yes | yes
4637 Arguments : none
4638
4639 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
4640 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
4641 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
4642 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
4643 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
4644 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
4645 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
4646 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
4647 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01004648 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
4649 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
4650 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
4651 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
4652 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
4653 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
4654 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004655
4656 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4657 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4658
4659 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
4660
4661
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004662option redispatch
4663no option redispatch
4664 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4665 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4666 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004667 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004668
4669 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4670 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4671 be able to access the service anymore.
4672
4673 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
4674 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
4675
4676 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4677 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4678 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004679
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004680 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
4681 "redisp" keywords.
4682
4683 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4684 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4685
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004686 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004687
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004688
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02004689option redis-check
4690 Use redis health checks for server testing
4691 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4692 yes | no | yes | yes
4693 Arguments : none
4694
4695 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
4696 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
4697 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
4698 find the "+PONG" response message.
4699
4700 Example :
4701 option redis-check
4702
4703 See also : "option httpchk"
4704
4705
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004706option smtpchk
4707option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
4708 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
4709 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4710 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004711 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004712 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
4713 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
4714 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
4715
4716 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
4717 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
4718 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
4719
4720 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
4721 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
4722 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
4723 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
4724 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
4725 dead server.
4726
4727 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
4728 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
4729 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
4730 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
4731
4732 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
4733 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
4734 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4735 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4736 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
4737
4738 Example :
4739 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
4740
4741 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
4742
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004743
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02004744option socket-stats
4745no option socket-stats
4746
4747 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
4748 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4749 yes | yes | yes | no
4750
4751 Arguments : none
4752
4753
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004754option splice-auto
4755no option splice-auto
4756 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
4757 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4758 yes | yes | yes | yes
4759 Arguments : none
4760
4761 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
4762 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
4763 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
4764 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004765 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004766 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
4767 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
4768 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
4769 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4770
4771 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
4772 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
4773 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
4774 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
4775 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
4776 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
4777 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
4778 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
4779 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
4780 keyword.
4781
4782 Example :
4783 option splice-auto
4784
4785 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4786 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4787
4788 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
4789 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4790
4791
4792option splice-request
4793no option splice-request
4794 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
4795 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4796 yes | yes | yes | yes
4797 Arguments : none
4798
4799 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004800 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004801 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4802 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4803 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4804 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4805
4806 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4807
4808 Example :
4809 option splice-request
4810
4811 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4812 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4813
4814 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
4815 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4816
4817
4818option splice-response
4819no option splice-response
4820 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
4821 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4822 yes | yes | yes | yes
4823 Arguments : none
4824
4825 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004826 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004827 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4828 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4829 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4830 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4831
4832 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4833
4834 Example :
4835 option splice-response
4836
4837 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4838 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4839
4840 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
4841 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4842
4843
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004844option srvtcpka
4845no option srvtcpka
4846 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
4847 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4848 yes | no | yes | yes
4849 Arguments : none
4850
4851 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4852 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4853 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4854 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4855
4856 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4857 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4858 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4859 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4860
4861 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4862 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4863 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4864 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4865 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4866
4867 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4868
4869 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4870 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4871 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
4872
4873 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4874 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4875
4876 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
4877
4878
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004879option ssl-hello-chk
4880 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
4881 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4882 yes | no | yes | yes
4883 Arguments : none
4884
4885 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
4886 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
4887 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
4888 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
4889 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
4890 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
4891 hello message.
4892
4893 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
4894 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
4895 messages, which is appreciable.
4896
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004897 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
4898 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
4899 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004900
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004901 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
4902
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004903
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004904option tcp-check
4905 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
4906 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4907 yes | no | yes | yes
4908
4909 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
4910 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
4911
4912 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
4913 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
4914 attempt, which remains the default mode.
4915
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004916 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004917 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
4918 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
4919 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
4920 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
4921 only.
4922
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004923 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004924 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
4925 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
4926 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
4927 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
4928
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004929 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004930 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
4931 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004932 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004933 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
4934 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
4935 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
4936 the respective protocols.
4937 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
4938 analysed.
4939
4940 Examples :
4941 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
4942 option tcp-check
4943 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
4944
4945 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
4946 option tcp-check
4947 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
4948
4949 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
4950 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004951 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004952 option tcp-check
4953 tcp-check send PING\r\n
4954 tcp-check expect +PONG
4955 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
4956 tcp-check expect string role:master
4957 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
4958 tcp-check expect string +OK
4959
4960 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
4961 (send many headers before analyzing)
4962 option tcp-check
4963 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
4964 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
4965 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
4966 tcp-check send \r\n
4967 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..)
4968
4969
4970 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
4971
4972
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004973option tcp-smart-accept
4974no option tcp-smart-accept
4975 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
4976 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4977 yes | yes | yes | no
4978 Arguments : none
4979
4980 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
4981 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
4982 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
4983 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
4984 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
4985 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
4986
4987 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
4988 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
4989 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
4990 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
4991
4992 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
4993 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
4994 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
4995 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
4996
4997 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
4998 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
4999 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
5000
5001 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
5002 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
5003 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
5004
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02005005 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
5006
5007
5008option tcp-smart-connect
5009no option tcp-smart-connect
5010 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
5011 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5012 yes | no | yes | yes
5013 Arguments : none
5014
5015 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
5016 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
5017 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
5018 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
5019 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
5020
5021 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
5022 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
5023 complex.
5024
5025 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
5026 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
5027 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
5028
5029 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5030 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5031
5032 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
5033
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005034
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005035option tcpka
5036 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
5037 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5038 yes | yes | yes | yes
5039 Arguments : none
5040
5041 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5042 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5043 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5044 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5045
5046 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5047 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5048 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5049 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5050
5051 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5052 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5053 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5054 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5055 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5056
5057 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5058
5059 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
5060 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
5061 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
5062 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
5063 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
5064 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
5065 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
5066 backends.
5067
5068 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
5069
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005070
5071option tcplog
5072 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
5073 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5074 yes | yes | yes | yes
5075 Arguments : none
5076
5077 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5078 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5079 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
5080 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
5081 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
5082 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
5083 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
5084 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
5085
5086 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5087
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005088 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005089
5090
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005091option transparent
5092no option transparent
5093 Enable client-side transparent proxying
5094 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01005095 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005096 Arguments : none
5097
5098 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
5099 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
5100 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
5101 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
5102 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
5103 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
5104 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
5105 appropriate server.
5106
5107 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
5108 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
5109
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01005110 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005111 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005112
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005113
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005114persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02005115persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005116 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
5117 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5118 yes | no | yes | yes
5119 Arguments :
5120 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005121 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
5122 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005123
5124 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
5125 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
5126 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
5127 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
5128 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
5129 forwarded to this server.
5130
5131 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
5132 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
5133 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005134 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005135 a single "listen" section.
5136
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005137 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
5138 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
5139 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
5140
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005141 Example :
5142 listen tse-farm
5143 bind :3389
5144 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
5145 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5146 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
5147 # apply RDP cookie persistence
5148 persist rdp-cookie
5149 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005150 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005151 balance rdp-cookie
5152 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
5153 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
5154
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09005155 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
5156 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005157
5158
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005159rate-limit sessions <rate>
5160 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
5161 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5162 yes | yes | yes | no
5163 Arguments :
5164 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
5165 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
5166
5167 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
5168 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
5169 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
5170 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
5171 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
5172 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
5173
5174 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
5175 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
5176 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
5177 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
5178
5179 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
5180 listen smtp
5181 mode tcp
5182 bind :25
5183 rate-limit sessions 10
5184 server 127.0.0.1:1025
5185
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02005186 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
5187 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
5188 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005189
5190 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
5191
5192
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005193redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5194redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5195redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005196 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
5197 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5198 no | yes | yes | yes
5199
5200 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01005201 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005202
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005203 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005204 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005205 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
5206 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
5207 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005208
5209 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
5210 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
5211 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
5212 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
5213 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005214 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
5215 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
5216 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
5217 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005218
5219 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
5220 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
5221 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
5222 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
5223 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
5224 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005225 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005226 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005227 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
5228 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
5229 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005230
5231 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01005232 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
5233 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
5234 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
5235 means "Moved permanently" and means that the browser should not
5236 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
5237 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
5238 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
5239 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005240
5241 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
5242 expected behaviour of a redirection :
5243
5244 - "drop-query"
5245 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
5246 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
5247 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
5248 with a location-type redirect.
5249
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005250 - "append-slash"
5251 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
5252 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
5253 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
5254 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
5255
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005256 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
5257 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
5258 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
5259 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
5260 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
5261 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
5262 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
5263
5264 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
5265 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
5266 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
5267 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
5268 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
5269 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
5270 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005271
5272 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
5273 acl clear dst_port 80
5274 acl secure dst_port 8080
5275 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005276 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005277 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005278 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
5279
5280 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005281 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
5282 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
5283 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005284 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005285
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005286 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
5287 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
5288 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
5289
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005290 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01005291 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005292
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005293 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
5294 http-request redirect code 301 location www.%[hdr(host)]%[req.uri] \
5295 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
5296
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005297 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005298
5299
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005300redisp (deprecated)
5301redispatch (deprecated)
5302 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5303 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5304 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005305 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005306
5307 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5308 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5309 be able to access the service anymore.
5310
5311 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
5312 redistribute them to a working server.
5313
5314 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
5315 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5316 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005317
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005318 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
5319 "option redispatch" instead.
5320
5321 See also : "option redispatch"
5322
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005323
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005324reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005325 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
5326 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5327 no | yes | yes | yes
5328 Arguments :
5329 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5330 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005331 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005332
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005333 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5334 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5335
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005336 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5337 the last header of an HTTP request.
5338
5339 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5340 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5341 responses.
5342
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005343 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
5344 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
5345 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
5346
5347 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5348 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005349
5350
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005351reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5352reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005353 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5354 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5355 no | yes | yes | yes
5356 Arguments :
5357 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5358 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5359 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5360 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5361 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5362 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
5363 ignores case.
5364
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005365 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5366 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5367
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005368 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5369 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
5370 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5371 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005372 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005373
5374 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5375 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5376
5377 Example :
5378 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
5379 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5380 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5381
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005382 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
5383 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005384
5385
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005386reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5387reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005388 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
5389 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5390 no | yes | yes | yes
5391 Arguments :
5392 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5393 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5394 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5395 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5396 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
5397 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
5398
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005399 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5400 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5401
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005402 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
5403 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
5404 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
5405 next servers.
5406
5407 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5408 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5409 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5410
5411 Example :
5412 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
5413 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
5414 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
5415
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005416 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5417 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005418
5419
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005420reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5421reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005422 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5423 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5424 no | yes | yes | yes
5425 Arguments :
5426 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5427 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5428 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5429 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5430 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5431 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
5432 case.
5433
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005434 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5435 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5436
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005437 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5438 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
5439 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5440 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005441 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005442
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005443 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005444 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005445 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005446
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005447 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5448 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5449
5450 Example :
5451 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
5452 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5453 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5454
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005455 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5456 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005457
5458
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005459reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5460reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005461 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
5462 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5463 no | yes | yes | yes
5464 Arguments :
5465 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5466 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5467 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5468 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5469 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5470 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
5471 case.
5472
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005473 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5474 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5475
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005476 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5477 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
5478 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
5479 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5480
5481 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5482 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5483
5484 Example :
5485 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
5486 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
5487 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5488 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5489
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005490 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5491 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005492
5493
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005494reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5495reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005496 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
5497 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5498 no | yes | yes | yes
5499 Arguments :
5500 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5501 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5502 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5503 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5504 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
5505 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
5506
5507 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5508 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5509 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5510 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005511 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005512
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005513 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5514 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5515
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005516 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
5517 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
5518 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
5519
5520 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5521 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5522 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5523 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
5524 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5525
5526 Example :
5527 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005528 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005529 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
5530 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
5531
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04005532 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
5533 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005534
5535
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005536reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5537reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005538 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
5539 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5540 no | yes | yes | yes
5541 Arguments :
5542 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5543 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5544 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5545 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5546 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5547 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
5548 ignores case.
5549
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005550 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5551 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5552
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005553 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5554 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005555 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
5556 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
5557 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005558 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
5559 not set.
5560
5561 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
5562 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
5563 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
5564 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
5565 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
5566
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005567 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005568 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
5569 # block all others.
5570 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
5571 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
5572
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005573 # block bad guys
5574 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
5575 reqitarpit . if badguys
5576
5577 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
5578 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005579
5580
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02005581retries <value>
5582 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
5583 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5584 yes | no | yes | yes
5585 Arguments :
5586 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
5587 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
5588 default value is 3.
5589
5590 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
5591 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
5592 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
5593
5594 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
5595 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
5596
5597 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
5598 server even if a cookie references a different server.
5599
5600 See also : "option redispatch"
5601
5602
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005603rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005604 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
5605 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5606 no | yes | yes | yes
5607 Arguments :
5608 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5609 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005610 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005611
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005612 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5613 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5614
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005615 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5616 the last header of an HTTP response.
5617
5618 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5619 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5620 responses.
5621
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005622 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5623 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005624
5625
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005626rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5627rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005628 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
5629 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5630 no | yes | yes | yes
5631 Arguments :
5632 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5633 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5634 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5635 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5636 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5637 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
5638 ignores case.
5639
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005640 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5641 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5642
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005643 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
5644 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005645 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005646 client.
5647
5648 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5649 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5650 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5651
5652 Example :
5653 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02005654 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005655
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005656 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5657 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005658
5659
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005660rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5661rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005662 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
5663 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5664 no | yes | yes | yes
5665 Arguments :
5666 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5667 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5668 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5669 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5670 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5671 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
5672 ignores case.
5673
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005674 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5675 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5676
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005677 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5678 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
5679 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
5680 case-sensitive.
5681
5682 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005683 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
5684 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
5685 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005686
5687 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5688 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
5689
5690 Example :
5691 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
5692 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
5693
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005694 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
5695 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005696
5697
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005698rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5699rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005700 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
5701 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5702 no | yes | yes | yes
5703 Arguments :
5704 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5705 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5706 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5707 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5708 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5709 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
5710 ignores case.
5711
5712 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5713 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5714 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5715 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005716 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005717
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005718 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5719 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5720
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005721 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
5722 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
5723 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
5724
5725 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5726 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5727 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5728 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
5729 are not case-sensitive.
5730
5731 Example :
5732 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
5733 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
5734
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005735 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
5736 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005737
5738
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005739server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005740 Declare a server in a backend
5741 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5742 no | no | yes | yes
5743 Arguments :
5744 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02005745 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005746 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005747
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005748 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
5749 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
5750 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
5751 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02005752 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
5753 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
5754 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
5755 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
5756 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005757 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
5758 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
5759 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
5760 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
5761 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5762 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5763 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02005764 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005765 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5766 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5767 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5768 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005769
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02005770 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005771 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
5772 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
5773 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
5774 adding this value to the client's port.
5775
5776 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
5777 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005778 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005779
5780 Examples :
5781 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
5782 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005783 server transp ipv4@
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005784 server backup ${SRV_BACKUP}:1080 backup
5785 server www1_dc1 ${LAN_DC1}.101:80
5786 server www1_dc2 ${LAN_DC2}.101:80
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005787
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005788 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
5789 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005790
5791
5792source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005793source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005794source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005795 Set the source address for outgoing connections
5796 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5797 yes | no | yes | yes
5798 Arguments :
5799 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
5800 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005801
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005802 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005803 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
5804 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
5805 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
5806 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
5807 supported prefixes are :
5808 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5809 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5810 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02005811 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005812 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5813 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5814 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5815 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005816
5817 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
5818 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02005819 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
5820 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
5821 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005822
5823 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
5824 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
5825 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
5826 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
5827 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
5828 <addr>.
5829
5830 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
5831 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
5832 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
5833 port.
5834
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005835 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
5836 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
5837 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
5838 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01005839 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005840 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
5841 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
5842 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
5843 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
5844 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
5845 HTTP header.
5846
5847 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
5848 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005849 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005850 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
5851 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
5852 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
5853 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
5854 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
5855 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
5856 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
5857
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005858 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
5859 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
5860 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
5861 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
5862 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
5863 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
5864
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005865 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
5866 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
5867 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
5868 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
5869
5870 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
5871 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
5872 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
5873 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
5874 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
5875 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
5876
5877 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
5878 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
5879 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
5880 there are two methods :
5881
5882 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
5883 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
5884 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
5885 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
5886 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
5887 of the client ranges may be used.
5888
5889 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
5890 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
5891 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
5892 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
5893 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
5894 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
5895 same session.
5896
5897 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
5898 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
5899 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
5900 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
5901 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
5902 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
5903
5904 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
5905 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
5906 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005907 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005908
5909 Examples :
5910 backend private
5911 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
5912 source 192.168.1.200
5913
5914 backend transparent_ssl1
5915 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
5916 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5917
5918 backend transparent_ssl2
5919 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
5920 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
5921 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
5922
5923 backend transparent_ssl3
5924 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
5925 # is more conntrack-friendly.
5926 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5927
5928 backend transparent_smtp
5929 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
5930 # with Tproxy version 4.
5931 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
5932
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005933 backend transparent_http
5934 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
5935 # proxy.
5936 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
5937
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005938 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005939 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
5940
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005941
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005942srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
5943 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
5944 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5945 yes | no | yes | yes
5946 Arguments :
5947 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
5948 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5949 as explained at the top of this document.
5950
5951 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
5952 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
5953 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
5954 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
5955 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
5956 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
5957 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
5958
5959 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
5960 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
5961 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
5962 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
5963 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005964 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005965 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005966 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005967
5968 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
5969 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
5970 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
5971 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
5972 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
5973 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
5974
5975 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
5976 Please use "timeout server" instead.
5977
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005978 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
5979 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005980
5981
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005982stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
5983 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
5984 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02005985 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005986
5987 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
5988 matched.
5989
5990 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
5991 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
5992
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005993 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5994 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5995 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5996
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01005997 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
5998 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
5999 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
6000 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006001
6002 Example :
6003 # statistics admin level only for localhost
6004 backend stats_localhost
6005 stats enable
6006 stats admin if LOCALHOST
6007
6008 Example :
6009 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
6010 backend stats_auth
6011 stats enable
6012 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
6013 stats admin if TRUE
6014
6015 Example :
6016 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
6017 userlist stats-auth
6018 group admin users admin
6019 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
6020 group readonly users haproxy
6021 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
6022
6023 backend stats_auth
6024 stats enable
6025 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
6026 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
6027 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
6028 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
6029
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006030 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
6031 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6032 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006033
6034
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006035stats auth <user>:<passwd>
6036 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
6037 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006038 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006039 Arguments :
6040 <user> is a user name to grant access to
6041
6042 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
6043
6044 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
6045 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
6046 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
6047 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
6048 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
6049 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
6050
6051 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
6052 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
6053 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006054 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006055
6056 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
6057 report using "stats scope".
6058
6059 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6060 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6061 unobvious parameters.
6062
6063 Example :
6064 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6065 backend public_www
6066 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6067 stats enable
6068 stats hide-version
6069 stats scope .
6070 stats uri /admin?stats
6071 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6072 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6073 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6074
6075 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6076 backend private_monitoring
6077 stats enable
6078 stats uri /admin?stats
6079 stats refresh 5s
6080
6081 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
6082
6083
6084stats enable
6085 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
6086 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006087 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006088 Arguments : none
6089
6090 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
6091 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
6092 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
6093 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
6094 - stats auth : no authentication
6095 - stats scope : no restriction
6096
6097 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6098 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6099 unobvious parameters.
6100
6101 Example :
6102 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6103 backend public_www
6104 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6105 stats enable
6106 stats hide-version
6107 stats scope .
6108 stats uri /admin?stats
6109 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6110 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6111 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6112
6113 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6114 backend private_monitoring
6115 stats enable
6116 stats uri /admin?stats
6117 stats refresh 5s
6118
6119 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6120
6121
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006122stats hide-version
6123 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006124 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006125 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006126 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006127
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006128 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
6129 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
6130 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
6131 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
6132 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
6133 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006134
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006135 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6136 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6137 unobvious parameters.
6138
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006139 Example :
6140 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6141 backend public_www
6142 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006143 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006144 stats hide-version
6145 stats scope .
6146 stats uri /admin?stats
6147 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6148 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6149 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006150
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006151 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6152 backend private_monitoring
6153 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006154 stats uri /admin?stats
6155 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01006156
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006157 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006158
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006159
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02006160stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
6161 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6162 Access control for statistics
6163
6164 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6165 no | no | yes | yes
6166
6167 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
6168 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
6169 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
6170 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
6171 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
6172 should be asked to enter a username and password.
6173
6174 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
6175 instance.
6176
6177 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6178 about ACL usage.
6179
6180
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006181stats realm <realm>
6182 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
6183 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006184 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006185 Arguments :
6186 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
6187 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
6188 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
6189
6190 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
6191 using a backslash ('\').
6192
6193 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
6194 only related to authentication.
6195
6196 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6197 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6198 unobvious parameters.
6199
6200 Example :
6201 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6202 backend public_www
6203 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6204 stats enable
6205 stats hide-version
6206 stats scope .
6207 stats uri /admin?stats
6208 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6209 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6210 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6211
6212 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6213 backend private_monitoring
6214 stats enable
6215 stats uri /admin?stats
6216 stats refresh 5s
6217
6218 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
6219
6220
6221stats refresh <delay>
6222 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
6223 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006224 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006225 Arguments :
6226 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
6227 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
6228 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
6229 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
6230 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
6231 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
6232
6233 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
6234 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
6235 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
6236 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
6237
6238 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6239 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6240 unobvious parameters.
6241
6242 Example :
6243 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6244 backend public_www
6245 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6246 stats enable
6247 stats hide-version
6248 stats scope .
6249 stats uri /admin?stats
6250 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6251 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6252 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6253
6254 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6255 backend private_monitoring
6256 stats enable
6257 stats uri /admin?stats
6258 stats refresh 5s
6259
6260 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6261
6262
6263stats scope { <name> | "." }
6264 Enable statistics and limit access scope
6265 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006266 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006267 Arguments :
6268 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
6269 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
6270 section in which the statement appears.
6271
6272 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
6273 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
6274 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
6275 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
6276 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
6277 exists.
6278
6279 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6280 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6281 unobvious parameters.
6282
6283 Example :
6284 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6285 backend public_www
6286 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6287 stats enable
6288 stats hide-version
6289 stats scope .
6290 stats uri /admin?stats
6291 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6292 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6293 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6294
6295 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6296 backend private_monitoring
6297 stats enable
6298 stats uri /admin?stats
6299 stats refresh 5s
6300
6301 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6302
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006303
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006304stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006305 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
6306 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006307 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006308
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006309 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006310 description from global section is automatically used instead.
6311
6312 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6313 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
6314
6315 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6316 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006317 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006318
6319 Example :
6320 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6321 backend private_monitoring
6322 stats enable
6323 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
6324 stats uri /admin?stats
6325 stats refresh 5s
6326
6327 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
6328 global section.
6329
6330
6331stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006332 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
6333 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6334 yes | yes | yes | yes
6335 Arguments : none
6336
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006337 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006338 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
6339 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
6340 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
6341 - IP (socket, server)
6342 - cookie (backend, server)
6343
6344 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6345 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006346 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006347
6348 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
6349
6350
6351stats show-node [ <name> ]
6352 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
6353 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006354 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006355 Arguments:
6356 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
6357 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
6358
6359 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6360 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006361 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006362
6363 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6364 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6365 unobvious parameters.
6366
6367 Example:
6368 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6369 backend private_monitoring
6370 stats enable
6371 stats show-node Europe-1
6372 stats uri /admin?stats
6373 stats refresh 5s
6374
6375 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
6376 section.
6377
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006378
6379stats uri <prefix>
6380 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
6381 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006382 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006383 Arguments :
6384 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
6385 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
6386 query string.
6387
6388 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
6389 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
6390 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
6391 possible to reach it in the application.
6392
6393 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006394 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006395 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
6396 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
6397 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
6398 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
6399
6400 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
6401 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
6402 an address or a port to statistics only.
6403
6404 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6405 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6406 unobvious parameters.
6407
6408 Example :
6409 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6410 backend public_www
6411 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6412 stats enable
6413 stats hide-version
6414 stats scope .
6415 stats uri /admin?stats
6416 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6417 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6418 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6419
6420 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6421 backend private_monitoring
6422 stats enable
6423 stats uri /admin?stats
6424 stats refresh 5s
6425
6426 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
6427
6428
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006429stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
6430 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006431 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006432 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006433
6434 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006435 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006436 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6437 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
6438 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
6439
6440 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6441 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6442 the "stick-table" statement.
6443
6444 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
6445 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
6446 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
6447 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
6448 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
6449
6450 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6451 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
6452 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
6453 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
6454 transformation rules.
6455
6456 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6457 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6458 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6459 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6460 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6461 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6462 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6463
6464 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
6465 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
6466 ACL based conditions.
6467
6468 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
6469 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
6470 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
6471 matches can be used as fallbacks.
6472
6473 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
6474 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
6475 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
6476 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
6477
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006478 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6479 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6480 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6481
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006482 Example :
6483 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6484 # last 30 minutes
6485 backend pop
6486 mode tcp
6487 balance roundrobin
6488 stick store-request src
6489 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6490 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6491 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6492
6493 backend smtp
6494 mode tcp
6495 balance roundrobin
6496 stick match src table pop
6497 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6498 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6499
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006500 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
6501 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006502
6503
6504stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6505 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
6506 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6507 no | no | yes | yes
6508
6509 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
6510 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
6511 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
6512 for writing more maintainable configurations.
6513
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006514 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6515 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6516 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6517
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006518 Examples :
6519 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01006520 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006521
6522 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
6523 stick match src table pop if !localhost
6524 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
6525
6526
6527 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
6528 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
6529 backend http
6530 mode http
6531 balance roundrobin
6532 stick on src table https
6533 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
6534 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
6535 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
6536
6537 backend https
6538 mode tcp
6539 balance roundrobin
6540 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6541 stick on src
6542 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6543 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6544
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006545 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006546
6547
6548stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6549 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6550 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6551 no | no | yes | yes
6552
6553 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006554 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006555 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6556 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6557 server is selected.
6558
6559 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6560 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6561 the "stick-table" statement.
6562
6563 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6564 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6565 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
6566 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
6567 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
6568 address.
6569
6570 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6571 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
6572 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
6573 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
6574 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
6575 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
6576 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
6577 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
6578 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
6579 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
6580
6581 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6582 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6583 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6584 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6585 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6586 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6587 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6588
6589 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
6590 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6591 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
6592 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6593
6594 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
6595 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6596 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6597 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6598 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6599 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01006600 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
6601 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
6602 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
6603 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
6604 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
6605 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006606
6607 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
6608 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
6609 the request.
6610
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006611 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6612 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6613 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6614
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006615 Example :
6616 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6617 # last 30 minutes
6618 backend pop
6619 mode tcp
6620 balance roundrobin
6621 stick store-request src
6622 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6623 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6624 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6625
6626 backend smtp
6627 mode tcp
6628 balance roundrobin
6629 stick match src table pop
6630 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6631 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6632
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006633 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
6634 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006635
6636
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006637stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006638 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
6639 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08006640 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006641 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006642 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006643
6644 Arguments :
6645 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
6646 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
6647 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6648 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6649
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01006650 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
6651 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
6652 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6653 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6654
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006655 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
6656 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
6657 instance.
6658
6659 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
6660 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
6661 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6662 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
6663 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
6664 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006665 to 32 characters.
6666
6667 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
6668 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
6669 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6670 being stored. If the block provided by the pattern extractor
6671 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
6672 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006673
6674 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006675 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
6676 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006677 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
6678 increase.
6679
6680 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006681 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
6682 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
6683 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006684
6685 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
6686 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
6687 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
6688 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
6689 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
6690 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
6691 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
6692 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
6693 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
6694 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
6695 parameter (see below).
6696
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006697 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
6698 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
6699 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
6700 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
6701 soft restart.
6702
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006703 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
6704
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006705 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
6706 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
6707 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
6708 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
6709 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006710 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006711 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
6712 if not expiration delay is specified.
6713
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006714 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
6715 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
6716 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
6717 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006718 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
6719 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
6720 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
6721 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
6722 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
6723 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
6724 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
6725 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
6726 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
6727 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
6728 types and their arguments.
6729
6730 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
6731 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
6732 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
6733 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
6734
6735 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
6736 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
6737 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
6738 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
6739
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02006740 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
6741 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
6742 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
6743 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
6744 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
6745 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
6746
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006747 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6748 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
6749 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
6750 they were received.
6751
6752 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6753 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
6754 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
6755 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
6756 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
6757
6758 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6759 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6760 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6761 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
6762 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6763
6764 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6765 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
6766 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
6767
6768 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6769 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6770 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6771 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
6772 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6773
6774 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6775 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
6776 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
6777 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
6778 the client side.
6779
6780 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6781 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6782 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6783 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
6784 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
6785 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
6786 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
6787
6788 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6789 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
6790 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
6791 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
6792 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
6793 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
6794 (eg: vulnerability scan).
6795
6796 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6797 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6798 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6799 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
6800 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
6801 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6802
6803 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6804 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
6805 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
6806 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
6807
6808 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6809 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6810 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6811 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6812 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6813 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
6814 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
6815 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
6816 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
6817 recommended for better fairness.
6818
6819 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6820 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
6821 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
6822 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
6823
6824 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
6825 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6826 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6827 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6828 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6829 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
6830 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
6831 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
6832 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
6833 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006834
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006835 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
6836 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006837 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
6838 reference it.
6839
6840 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
6841 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
6842 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
6843 as an exclusive stickiness.
6844
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006845 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
6846 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
6847 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
6848 something that can be ignored.
6849
6850 Example:
6851 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
6852 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
6853 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
6854 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
6855
6856 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01006857 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006858
6859
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006860stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6861 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6862 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6863 no | no | yes | yes
6864
6865 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006866 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006867 describes what elements of the response or connection will
6868 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6869 server is selected.
6870
6871 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6872 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6873 the "stick-table" statement.
6874
6875 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6876 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6877 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
6878 when the response is a SSL server hello.
6879
6880 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6881 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
6882 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
6883 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
6884 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
6885 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006886 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006887 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
6888 rules.
6889
6890 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6891 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6892 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6893 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6894 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6895 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6896 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6897
6898 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
6899 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6900 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
6901 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6902
6903 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
6904 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6905 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6906 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6907 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6908 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01006909 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
6910 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
6911 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
6912 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
6913 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
6914 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
6915 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
6916 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
6917 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006918
6919 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
6920
6921 Example :
6922 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
6923 backend https
6924 mode tcp
6925 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006926 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006927 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006928
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006929 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
6930 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
6931
6932 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
6933 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6934 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
6935
6936 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
6937 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006938
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006939 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
6940 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
6941 # at offset 44.
6942
6943 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
6944 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
6945
6946 # Learn on response if server hello.
6947 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006948
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006949 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6950 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6951
6952 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
6953 extraction.
6954
6955
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02006956tcp-check connect [params*]
6957 Opens a new connection
6958 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6959 no | no | yes | yes
6960
6961 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
6962 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
6963 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
6964
6965 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
6966 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
6967 of the sequence.
6968
6969 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
6970 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
6971 do.
6972
6973 Parameters :
6974 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
6975 use the TCP connection.
6976
6977 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
6978 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
6979 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
6980
6981 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
6982
6983 ssl opens a ciphered connection
6984
6985 Examples:
6986 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
6987 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
6988 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
6989 option tcp-check
6990 tcp-check connect
6991 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
6992 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
6993 tcp-check send \r\n
6994 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
6995 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
6996 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
6997 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
6998 tcp-check send \r\n
6999 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7000 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
7001
7002 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
7003 option tcp-check
7004 tcp-check connect port 110
7005 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7006 tcp-check connect port 143
7007 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7008 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
7009
7010 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
7011
7012
7013tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
7014 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
7015 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7016 no | no | yes | yes
7017
7018 Arguments :
7019 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
7020 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
7021 binary.
7022 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
7023 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
7024 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
7025
7026 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
7027 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
7028 with the usual backslash ('\').
7029 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
7030 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
7031 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
7032 used upper or lower case.
7033
7034
7035 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
7036
7037 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
7038 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7039 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
7040 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7041 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
7042 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
7043 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
7044 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
7045
7046 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
7047 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7048 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
7049 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7050 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
7051 expression.
7052
7053 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
7054 in the response buffer. A health check response will
7055 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
7056 this exact hexadecimal string.
7057 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
7058
7059 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
7060 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
7061 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
7062 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
7063 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
7064 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
7065 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
7066 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
7067 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
7068 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
7069 the null character.
7070
7071 Examples :
7072 # perform a POP check
7073 option tcp-check
7074 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7075
7076 # perform an IMAP check
7077 option tcp-check
7078 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7079
7080 # look for the redis master server
7081 option tcp-check
7082 tcp-check send PING\r\n
7083 tcp-check expect +PONG
7084 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7085 tcp-check expect string role:master
7086 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7087 tcp-check expect string +OK
7088
7089
7090 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
7091 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
7092
7093
7094tcp-check send <data>
7095 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7096 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7097 no | no | yes | yes
7098
7099 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7100 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7101
7102 Examples :
7103 # look for the redis master server
7104 option tcp-check
7105 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7106 tcp-check expect string role:master
7107
7108 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7109 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
7110
7111
7112tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
7113 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
7114 tcp health check
7115 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7116 no | no | yes | yes
7117
7118 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7119 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7120 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
7121 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
7122 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
7123 hexadecimal string.
7124 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
7125
7126 Examples :
7127 # redis check in binary
7128 option tcp-check
7129 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
7130 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
7131
7132
7133 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7134 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
7135
7136
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007137tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7138 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007139 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7140 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007141 Arguments :
7142 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007143 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
7144 "track-sc2", and "expect-proxy". See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007145
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007146 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007147
7148 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
7149 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007150 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
7151 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
7152 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
7153 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
7154 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
7155 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007156
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007157 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
7158 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
7159 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
7160 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007161
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007162 Three types of actions are supported :
7163 - accept :
7164 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7165 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7166 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007167
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007168 - reject :
7169 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7170 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7171 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
7172 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
7173 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
7174 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
7175 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
7176 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
7177 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
7178 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
7179 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
7180 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007181
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007182 - expect-proxy layer4 :
7183 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
7184 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
7185 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
7186 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
7187 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
7188 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
7189 hosts.
7190
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007191 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007192 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
7193 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
7194 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007195 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
7196 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007197 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007198 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
7199 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
7200 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
7201 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
7202 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007203
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007204 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007205 <key> is mandatory, and is a pattern extraction rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02007206 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007207 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
7208 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
7209 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
7210 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007211
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007212 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
7213 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
7214 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
7215 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007216
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007217 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
7218 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
7219 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
7220 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
7221 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007222 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
7223 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
7224 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
7225 layer7 information is extracted.
7226
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007227 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
7228 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
7229 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
7230 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
7231 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007232
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007233 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7234 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7235 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007236
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007237 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
7238 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
7239 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007240
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007241 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007242 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007243 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007244
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007245 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
7246 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
7247 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007248
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007249 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007250 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7251 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007252
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007253 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
7254
7255 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
7256
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007257 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7258
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007259 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007260
7261
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007262tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7263 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007264 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007265 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007266 Arguments :
7267 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007268 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
7269 and "track-sc2". See "tcp-request connection" above for their
Willy Tarreaue25c9172013-05-28 18:32:20 +02007270 signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007271
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007272 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007273
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007274 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
7275 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7276 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
7277 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
7278 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007279
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007280 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
7281 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
7282 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
7283 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007284 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
7285 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
7286 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
7287 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
7288 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
7289 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007290 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007291 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007292
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007293 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7294 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7295 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7296 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007297
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007298 Three types of actions are supported :
7299 - accept :
7300 - reject :
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007301 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007302
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007303 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
7304 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007305
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007306 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
7307 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
7308 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
7309 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
7310 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
7311 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007312
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007313 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007314 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7315 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007316
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007317 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007318 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
7319 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
7320 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
7321 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007322 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
7323 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
7324 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007325
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007326 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
7327 are present when the rule is processed. The current solution for making the
7328 rule engine wait for such information is to set an inspect delay and to
7329 condition its execution with an ACL relying on such information.
7330
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007331 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007332 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
7333 # and reject everything else.
7334 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
7335 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007336 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007337 tcp-request content reject
7338
7339 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007340 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
7341 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7342 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007343 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007344
7345 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
7346 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7347 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007348 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007349 tcp-request content reject
7350
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007351 Example:
7352 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
7353 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007354 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1) if HTTP
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007355
7356 Example:
7357 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
7358 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007359 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate if HTTP
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007360
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007361 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
7362 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
7363
7364 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007365 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007366 # protecting all our sites
7367 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007368 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7369 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007370 ...
7371 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
7372
7373 backend http_dynamic
7374 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007375 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007376 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007377 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7378 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
7379 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007380 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007381
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007382 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007383
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007384 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007385
7386
7387tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
7388 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
7389 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007390 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007391 Arguments :
7392 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7393 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7394 as explained at the top of this document.
7395
7396 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
7397 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
7398 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
7399 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
7400 data for at most the specified amount of time.
7401
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007402 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
7403 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
7404 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
7405 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
7406
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007407 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
7408 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007409 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007410 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01007411 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
7412 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
7413 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
7414 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007415
7416 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
7417 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
7418 it pass through unaffected.
7419
7420 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
7421 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
7422 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007423 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007424 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
7425 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02007426 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
7427 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
7428 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007429
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007430 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007431 "timeout client".
7432
7433
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007434tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7435 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
7436 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7437 no | no | yes | yes
7438 Arguments :
7439 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007440 actions include : "accept", "close", "reject".
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007441
7442 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
7443
7444 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
7445 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7446 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007447 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
7448 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007449
7450 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
7451
7452 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7453 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7454 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7455 inserted.
7456
7457 Two types of actions are supported :
7458 - accept :
7459 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7460 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7461 the rules evaluation.
7462
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007463 - close :
7464 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
7465 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
7466 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
7467 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
7468 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
7469 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007470 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007471 protocols.
7472
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007473 - reject :
7474 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7475 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007476 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007477
7478 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7479 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7480 for changing the default action to a reject.
7481
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007482 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
7483 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
7484 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
7485 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007486 period.
7487
7488 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7489
7490 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
7491
7492
7493tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
7494 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
7495 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7496 no | no | yes | yes
7497 Arguments :
7498 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7499 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7500 as explained at the top of this document.
7501
7502 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
7503
7504
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007505timeout check <timeout>
7506 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
7507 established.
7508
7509 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7510 yes | no | yes | yes
7511 Arguments:
7512 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7513 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7514 as explained at the top of this document.
7515
7516 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
7517 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
7518 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
7519 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01007520 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
7521 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
7522 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007523
7524 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
7525 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
7526
7527 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
7528 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007529 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007530
7531 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7532 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7533 forget about it.
7534
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007535 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
7536 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007537
7538
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007539timeout client <timeout>
7540timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7541 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
7542 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7543 yes | yes | yes | no
7544 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007545 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007546 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7547 as explained at the top of this document.
7548
7549 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
7550 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7551 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
7552 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
7553 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
7554 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
7555 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
7556 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007557 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007558 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007559 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
7560 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007561 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
7562 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007563
7564 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
7565 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7566 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7567 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7568 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7569 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7570
7571 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
7572 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
7573 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7574
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007575 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007576
7577
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007578timeout client-fin <timeout>
7579 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
7580 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7581 yes | yes | yes | no
7582 Arguments :
7583 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7584 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7585 as explained at the top of this document.
7586
7587 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
7588 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
7589 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
7590 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
7591 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
7592 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
7593 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
7594 down in one direction.
7595
7596 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
7597 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
7598 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
7599
7600 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
7601
7602
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007603timeout connect <timeout>
7604timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7605 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
7606 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7607 yes | no | yes | yes
7608 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007609 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007610 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7611 as explained at the top of this document.
7612
7613 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007614 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007615 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007616 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007617 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
7618 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007619
7620 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7621 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7622 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7623 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7624 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
7625 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7626
7627 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
7628 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
7629 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7630
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007631 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
7632 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007633
7634
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007635timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
7636 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
7637 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7638 yes | yes | yes | yes
7639 Arguments :
7640 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7641 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7642 as explained at the top of this document.
7643
7644 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
7645 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
7646 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
7647 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
7648 once the request has started to present itself.
7649
7650 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
7651 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
7652 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
7653 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
7654 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
7655
7656 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
7657 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
7658 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
7659 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
7660
7661 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
7662 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
7663 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
7664 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
7665 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02007666 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007667
7668 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
7669 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
7670 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
7671 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
7672
7673 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
7674
7675
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007676timeout http-request <timeout>
7677 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
7678 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007679 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007680 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007681 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007682 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7683 as explained at the top of this document.
7684
7685 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
7686 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
7687 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
7688 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
7689 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
7690 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
7691 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02007692 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
7693 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
7694 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
7695 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
7696 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
7697 code using "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See more details in the explanations of
7698 the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007699
7700 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
7701 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007702 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
7703 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007704
7705 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
7706 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
7707 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
7708 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
7709 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
7710
7711 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007712 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
7713 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
7714 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007715
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02007716 See also : "errorfile", "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007717
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007718
7719timeout queue <timeout>
7720 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
7721 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7722 yes | no | yes | yes
7723 Arguments :
7724 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7725 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7726 as explained at the top of this document.
7727
7728 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
7729 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
7730 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
7731 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
7732 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
7733
7734 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
7735 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
7736 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
7737 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
7738
7739 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
7740
7741
7742timeout server <timeout>
7743timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7744 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7745 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7746 yes | no | yes | yes
7747 Arguments :
7748 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7749 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7750 as explained at the top of this document.
7751
7752 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7753 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7754 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7755 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7756 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7757 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7758 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7759
7760 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7761 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7762 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7763 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7764 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007765 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007766 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007767 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
7768 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
7769 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
7770 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007771
7772 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7773 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7774 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7775 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7776 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7777 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7778
7779 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
7780 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
7781 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7782
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007783 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007784
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007785
7786timeout server-fin <timeout>
7787 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
7788 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7789 yes | no | yes | yes
7790 Arguments :
7791 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7792 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7793 as explained at the top of this document.
7794
7795 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7796 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
7797 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
7798 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
7799 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
7800 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
7801 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
7802 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
7803 situations, it should not be needed.
7804
7805 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7806 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
7807 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
7808
7809 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
7810
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007811
7812timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007813 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007814 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7815 yes | yes | yes | yes
7816 Arguments :
7817 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
7818 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7819 as explained at the top of this document.
7820
7821 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
7822 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
7823 defines how long it will be maintained open.
7824
7825 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7826 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7827 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
7828 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007829 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007830
7831 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
7832
7833
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007834timeout tunnel <timeout>
7835 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
7836 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7837 yes | no | yes | yes
7838 Arguments :
7839 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7840 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7841 as explained at the top of this document.
7842
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007843 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007844 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
7845 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
7846 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
7847 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
7848 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
7849 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
7850 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
7851 specified.
7852
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007853 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
7854 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
7855 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
7856 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
7857 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
7858 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
7859 state.
7860
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007861 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7862 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7863 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
7864 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
7865 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
7866
7867 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7868 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7869 forget about it.
7870
7871 Example :
7872 defaults http
7873 option http-server-close
7874 timeout connect 5s
7875 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007876 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007877 timeout server 30s
7878 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
7879
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007880 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007881
7882
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007883transparent (deprecated)
7884 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7885 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007886 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007887 Arguments : none
7888
7889 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
7890 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7891 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7892 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7893 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7894 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7895 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7896 appropriate server.
7897
7898 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
7899
7900 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7901 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7902
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007903 See also: "option transparent"
7904
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007905unique-id-format <string>
7906 Generate a unique ID for each request.
7907 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7908 yes | yes | yes | no
7909 Arguments :
7910 <string> is a log-format string.
7911
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007912 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
7913 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
7914 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
7915 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007916
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007917 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
7918 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
7919 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
7920 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
7921 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
7922 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
7923 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
7924 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007925
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007926 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
7927 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007928
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007929 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007930
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05007931 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007932
7933 will generate:
7934
7935 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
7936
7937 See also: "unique-id-header"
7938
7939unique-id-header <name>
7940 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
7941 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7942 yes | yes | yes | no
7943 Arguments :
7944 <name> is the name of the header.
7945
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007946 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
7947 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007948
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007949 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007950
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05007951 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007952 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
7953
7954 will generate:
7955
7956 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
7957
7958 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007959
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02007960use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02007961 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007962 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7963 no | yes | yes | no
7964 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01007965 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
7966 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007967
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02007968 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
7969 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007970
7971 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
7972 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
7973 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02007974 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
7975 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
7976 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
7977 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007978
7979 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
7980 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
7981 assign the backend.
7982
7983 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
7984 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
7985 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
7986 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
7987 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
7988 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
7989
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02007990 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007991 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02007992 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
7993 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
7994 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
7995
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01007996 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
7997 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
7998 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
7999 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
8000 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
8001 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
8002 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
8003 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
8004 cannot be forced from the request.
8005
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008006 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008007 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
8008 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
8009
8010 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
8011 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008012
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008013
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008014use-server <server> if <condition>
8015use-server <server> unless <condition>
8016 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
8017 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8018 no | no | yes | yes
8019 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008020 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008021
8022 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
8023
8024 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
8025 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
8026 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
8027
8028 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
8029 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
8030 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
8031 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
8032 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
8033 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
8034 matches will assign the server.
8035
8036 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
8037 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
8038 with the next rules until one matches.
8039
8040 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
8041 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8042 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
8043 according to other persistence mechanisms.
8044
8045 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
8046 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
8047 stripped.
8048
8049 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
8050 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
8051 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
8052 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
8053
8054 Example :
8055 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
8056 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
8057 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
8058 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
8059 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
8060 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
8061 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
8062 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
8063 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
8064
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008065 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008066
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008067
80685. Bind and Server options
8069--------------------------
8070
8071The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
8072depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
8073settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
8074written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
8075described in this section.
8076
8077
80785.1. Bind options
8079-----------------
8080
8081The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
8082as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
8083no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
8084parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
8085while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
8086provided immediately after the setting name.
8087
8088The currently supported settings are the following ones.
8089
8090accept-proxy
8091 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
8092 the sockets declared on the same line. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
8093 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
8094 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
8095 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
8096 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
8097 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
8098 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
8099 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008100 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
8101 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008102
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008103alpn <protocols>
8104 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
8105 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
8106 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
8107 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
8108 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
8109 initial NPN extension.
8110
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008111backlog <backlog>
8112 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
8113 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
8114
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008115ecdhe <named curve>
8116 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01008117 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
8118 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008119
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008120ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008121 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8122 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8123 client's certificate.
8124
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008125ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
8126 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8127 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
8128 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
8129 error is ignored.
8130
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008131ciphers <ciphers>
8132 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
8133 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008134 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008135 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
8136 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
8137
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008138crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008139 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8140 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8141 to verify client's certificate.
8142
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008143crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008144 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8145 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
8146 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
8147 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
8148 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
8149 file.
8150
8151 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
8152 are loaded.
8153
8154 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
8155 that directory will be loaded. This directive may be specified multiple times
8156 in order to load certificates from multiple files or directories. The
8157 certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server Name
8158 Indication field matching one of their CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are
8159 supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used instead of the first
8160 hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches www.example.org but not
8161 www.sub.example.org).
8162
8163 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
8164 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
8165 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
8166 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
8167 recommended to load the default one first as a file.
8168
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02008169 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008170
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008171 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
8172 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +08008173 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008174 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
8175 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
8176 clients).
8177
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008178crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008179 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
8180 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008181 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008182 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008183
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008184crt-list <file>
8185 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008186 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
8187 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008188
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008189 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008190
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008191 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
8192 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
8193 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
8194 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
8195 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
8196 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
8197 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
8198 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008199
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008200defer-accept
8201 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8202 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
8203 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
8204 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
8205 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
8206 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
8207 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
8208 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
8209 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
8210 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
8211 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
8212
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008213force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008214 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008215 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
8216 for high connection rates. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
8217
8218force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008219 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008220 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
8221
8222force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008223 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008224 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
8225
8226force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008227 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008228 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
8229
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008230gid <gid>
8231 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
8232 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8233 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
8234 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
8235 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8236
8237group <group>
8238 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
8239 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
8240 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
8241 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
8242 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8243
8244id <id>
8245 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
8246 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
8247 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
8248 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
8249
8250interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01008251 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
8252 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
8253 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
8254 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
8255 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
8256 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
8257 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008258
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02008259level <level>
8260 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
8261 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
8262 sockets. <level> can be one of :
8263 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
8264 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
8265 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
8266 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
8267 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
8268 counters).
8269 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
8270 all counters).
8271
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008272maxconn <maxconn>
8273 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
8274 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
8275 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
8276 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
8277 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
8278 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
8279 eat all memory.
8280
8281mode <mode>
8282 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
8283 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
8284 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
8285 UNIX sockets.
8286
8287mss <maxseg>
8288 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
8289 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
8290 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
8291 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
8292 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
8293 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
8294 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
8295 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
8296 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
8297 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
8298 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
8299
8300name <name>
8301 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
8302 page.
8303
8304nice <nice>
8305 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
8306 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
8307 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
8308 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
8309 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
8310 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
8311 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
8312 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
8313 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
8314 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
8315 one for an RDP socket.
8316
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008317no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008318 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008319 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008320 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008321 be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8322 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008323
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02008324no-tls-tickets
8325 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8326 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
8327 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
8328 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage.
8329
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008330no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008331 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008332 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008333 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
8334 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8335 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008336
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008337no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008338 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008339 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008340 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
8341 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8342 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008343
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008344no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008345 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008346 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008347 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
8348 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8349 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008350
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008351npn <protocols>
8352 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
8353 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
8354 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
8355 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008356 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
8357 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008358
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02008359process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
8360 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
8361 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
8362 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
8363 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
8364 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
8365 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
8366 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +02008367 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
8368 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
8369 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
8370 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
8371 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
8372 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
8373 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02008374
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008375ssl
8376 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008377 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008378 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
8379 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
8380 to deciphered contents.
8381
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01008382strict-sni
8383 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
8384 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
8385 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
8386 See the "crt" option for more information.
8387
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008388tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01008389 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008390 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
8391 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
8392 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
8393 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
8394 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
8395 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
8396 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +02008397 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
8398 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
8399 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008400
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008401transparent
8402 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8403 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
8404 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
8405 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
8406 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
8407 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
8408 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
8409 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
8410 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
8411 so check for support with your vendor.
8412
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008413v4v6
8414 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8415 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
8416 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
8417 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008418 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008419
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008420v6only
8421 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8422 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
8423 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008424 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
8425 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008426
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008427uid <uid>
8428 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
8429 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8430 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
8431 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
8432 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8433
8434user <user>
8435 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
8436 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8437 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
8438 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
8439 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8440
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008441verify [none|optional|required]
8442 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
8443 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
8444 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
8445 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
8446 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008447 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
8448 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
8449 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
8450 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008451
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020084525.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008453------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008454
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008455The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
8456which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
8457arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
8458settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
8459after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
8460Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
8461address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008462
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008463 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008464 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008465
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008466The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008467
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008468addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008469 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
8470 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
8471 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
8472 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
8473 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008474
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008475 Supported in default-server: No
8476
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008477agent-check
8478 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008479 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
8480 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
8481 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
8482 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008483
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008484 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008485 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
8486 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts.
8487
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008488 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8489 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008490
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008491 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8492 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
8493 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008494
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008495 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8496 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
8497 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008498
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008499 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
8500 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
8501 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
8502 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
8503 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
8504 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
8505 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008506
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008507 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
8508 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008509
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008510 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
8511 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
8512 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
8513 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
8514 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
8515 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
8516 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
8517 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
8518 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008519
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09008520 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
8521 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008522 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
8523 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
8524 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
8525 force an agent's result in order to workaround a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09008526
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008527 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
8528 parameter.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008529
8530 Supported in default-server: No
8531
8532agent-inter <delay>
8533 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
8534 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8535
8536 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
8537 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
8538 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
8539 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
8540 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8541 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8542 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8543 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8544 of backends use the same servers.
8545
8546 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
8547
8548 Supported in default-server: Yes
8549
8550agent-port <port>
8551 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
8552
8553 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
8554
8555 Supported in default-server: Yes
8556
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008557backup
8558 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
8559 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
8560 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
8561 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
8562 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
8563 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008564
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008565 Supported in default-server: No
8566
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008567ca-file <cafile>
8568 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8569 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8570 server's certificate.
8571
8572 Supported in default-server: No
8573
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008574check
8575 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01008576 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
8577 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
8578 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
8579 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
8580 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
8581 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
8582 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008583 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
8584 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
8585 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008586
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008587 Supported in default-server: No
8588
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02008589check-send-proxy
8590 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
8591 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
8592 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
8593 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
8594 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
8595 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
8596 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
8597
8598 Supported in default-server: No
8599
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008600check-ssl
8601 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
8602 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
8603 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
8604 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008605 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008606 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
8607 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
8608 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
8609 See the "ssl" option for more information.
8610
8611 Supported in default-server: No
8612
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008613ciphers <ciphers>
8614 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008615 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008616 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
8617 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
8618 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
8619 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
8620 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
8621 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
8622
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008623 Supported in default-server: No
8624
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008625cookie <value>
8626 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
8627 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
8628 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
8629 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
8630 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
8631 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
8632 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
8633
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008634 Supported in default-server: No
8635
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008636crl-file <crlfile>
8637 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8638 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8639 to verify server's certificate.
8640
8641 Supported in default-server: No
8642
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02008643crt <cert>
8644 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8645 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
8646 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
8647 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
8648 certificate request.
8649
8650 Supported in default-server: No
8651
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02008652disabled
8653 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
8654 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
8655 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
8656 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
8657 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
8658
8659 Supported in default-server: No
8660
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008661error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008662 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
8663 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
8664 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008665
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008666 Supported in default-server: Yes
8667
8668 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008669
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008670fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008671 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
8672 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
8673 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
8674
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008675 Supported in default-server: Yes
8676
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008677force-sslv3
8678 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8679 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
8680 high connection rates. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8681
8682 Supported in default-server: No
8683
8684force-tlsv10
8685 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8686 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8687
8688 Supported in default-server: No
8689
8690force-tlsv11
8691 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8692 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8693
8694 Supported in default-server: No
8695
8696force-tlsv12
8697 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8698 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8699
8700 Supported in default-server: No
8701
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008702id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02008703 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
8704 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
8705 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008706
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008707 Supported in default-server: No
8708
8709inter <delay>
8710fastinter <delay>
8711downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008712 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
8713 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8714 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
8715 between checks depending on the server state :
8716
8717 Server state | Interval used
8718 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8719 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
8720 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8721 Transitionally UP (going down), |
8722 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8723 or yet unchecked. |
8724 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8725 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8726 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008727
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008728 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
8729 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
8730 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
8731 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008732 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8733 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8734 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8735 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8736 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008737
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008738 Supported in default-server: Yes
8739
8740maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008741 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
8742 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
8743 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
8744 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
8745 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
8746 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
8747 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
8748 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
8749
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008750 Supported in default-server: Yes
8751
8752maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008753 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
8754 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
8755 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
8756 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
8757 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
8758 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
8759 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
8760
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008761 Supported in default-server: Yes
8762
8763minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008764 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
8765 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
8766 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
8767 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
8768 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
8769 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008770 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008771 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008772
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008773 Supported in default-server: Yes
8774
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008775no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008776 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
8777 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008778 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008779
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008780 Supported in default-server: No
8781
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02008782no-tls-tickets
8783 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8784 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
8785 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
8786 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers.
8787
8788 Supported in default-server: No
8789
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008790no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008791 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008792 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8793 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008794 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8795 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008796
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008797 Supported in default-server: No
8798
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008799no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008800 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008801 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8802 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008803 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8804 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008805
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008806 Supported in default-server: No
8807
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008808no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008809 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008810 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8811 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008812 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8813 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008814
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008815 Supported in default-server: No
8816
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09008817non-stick
8818 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
8819 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
8820 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
8821
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008822 Supported in default-server: No
8823
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008824observe <mode>
8825 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
8826 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
8827 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
8828 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
8829 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
8830 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01008831 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008832
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008833 Supported in default-server: No
8834
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008835 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
8836
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008837on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008838 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
8839 Currently, four modes are available:
8840 - fastinter: force fastinter
8841 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
8842 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
8843 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
8844 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
8845
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008846 Supported in default-server: Yes
8847
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008848 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
8849
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09008850on-marked-down <action>
8851 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
8852 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07008853 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
8854 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
8855 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
8856 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
8857 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
8858 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
8859 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
8860 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09008861
8862 Actions are disabled by default
8863
8864 Supported in default-server: Yes
8865
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07008866on-marked-up <action>
8867 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
8868 Currently one action is available:
8869 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
8870 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
8871 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
8872 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
8873 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
8874 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
8875 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
8876 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
8877
8878 Actions are disabled by default
8879
8880 Supported in default-server: Yes
8881
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008882port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008883 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
8884 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
8885 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
8886 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
8887 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
8888 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
8889
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008890 Supported in default-server: Yes
8891
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008892redir <prefix>
8893 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
8894 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
8895 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
8896 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
8897 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
8898 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
8899 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
8900 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008901 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008902 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
8903 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
8904 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
8905 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
8906 loop between the client and HAProxy!
8907
8908 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
8909
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008910 Supported in default-server: No
8911
8912rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008913 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
8914 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
8915 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
8916
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008917 Supported in default-server: Yes
8918
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01008919send-proxy
8920 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
8921 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
8922 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
8923 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
8924 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
8925 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
8926 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
8927 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
8928 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02008929 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
8930 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
8931 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
8932 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
8933 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01008934
8935 Supported in default-server: No
8936
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -04008937send-proxy-v2
8938 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
8939 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
8940 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
8941 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
8942 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
8943 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the "send-proxy"
8944 option of the "bind" keyword.
8945
8946 Supported in default-server: No
8947
8948send-proxy-v2-ssl
8949 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
8950 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
8951 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
8952 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
8953 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
8954 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
8955 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
8956 See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
8957
8958 Supported in default-server: No
8959
8960send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
8961 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
8962 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
8963 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
8964 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
8965 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
8966 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
8967 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
8968 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
8969 protocol. See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
8970
8971 Supported in default-server: No
8972
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008973slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008974 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
8975 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
8976 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
8977 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
8978 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
8979 parameters :
8980
8981 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
8982 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
8983
8984 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
8985 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
8986 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
8987 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
8988
8989 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
8990 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
8991 seen as failed.
8992
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008993 Supported in default-server: Yes
8994
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008995source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008996source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008997source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008998 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
8999 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
9000 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
9001 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
9002
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009003 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
9004 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
9005 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
9006 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
9007 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
9008 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
9009 server.
9010
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009011 Supported in default-server: No
9012
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009013ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009014 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
9015 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
9016 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
9017 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
9018 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
9019 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009020 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009021
9022 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009023
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009024track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +02009025 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
9026 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
9027 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
9028 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009029 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
9030
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009031 Supported in default-server: No
9032
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009033verify [none|required]
9034 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01009035 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
9036 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
9037 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
9038 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009039 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
9040 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
9041 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009042
9043 Supported in default-server: No
9044
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -07009045verifyhost <hostname>
9046 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
9047 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
9048 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
9049 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
9050 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
9051 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
9052
9053 Supported in default-server: No
9054
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009055weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009056 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
9057 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
9058 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02009059 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
9060 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
9061 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
9062 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
9063 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
9064 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009065
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009066 Supported in default-server: Yes
9067
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009068
90696. HTTP header manipulation
9070---------------------------
9071
9072In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
9073response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
9074request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
9075which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009076against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009077
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009078If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
9079to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
9080but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
9081HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
9082stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
9083because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
9084a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
9085still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02009086
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009087This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
9088in section 4.2 :
9089
9090 - reqadd <string>
9091 - reqallow <search>
9092 - reqiallow <search>
9093 - reqdel <search>
9094 - reqidel <search>
9095 - reqdeny <search>
9096 - reqideny <search>
9097 - reqpass <search>
9098 - reqipass <search>
9099 - reqrep <search> <replace>
9100 - reqirep <search> <replace>
9101 - reqtarpit <search>
9102 - reqitarpit <search>
9103 - rspadd <string>
9104 - rspdel <search>
9105 - rspidel <search>
9106 - rspdeny <search>
9107 - rspideny <search>
9108 - rsprep <search> <replace>
9109 - rspirep <search> <replace>
9110
9111With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
9112is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
9113parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
9114prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
9115Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
9116
9117 \t for a tab
9118 \r for a carriage return (CR)
9119 \n for a new line (LF)
9120 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
9121 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
9122 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
9123 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
9124 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
9125
9126The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
9127portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
9128above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
9129regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
91309 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
9131is very common to users of the "sed" program.
9132
9133The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
9134after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
9135
9136Notes related to these keywords :
9137---------------------------------
9138 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
9139 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
9140 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
9141
9142 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
9143 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
9144 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
9145
9146 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
9147 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
9148 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
9149 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
9150 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
9151
9152 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
9153 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
9154 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
9155 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
9156 useless headers before adding new ones.
9157
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009158 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009159 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
9160
9161 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
9162 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
9163 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
9164
9165 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
9166 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009167 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009168
9169
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020091707. Using ACLs and fetching samples
9171----------------------------------
9172
9173Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
9174client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
9175The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
9176these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
9177but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
9178data called patterns.
9179
9180
91817.1. ACL basics
9182---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009183
9184The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
9185content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
9186from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
9187simple :
9188
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009189 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009190 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009191 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
9192 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009193
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009194The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
9195adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009196
9197In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
9198
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009199 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009200
9201This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
9202Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
9203and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009204an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
9205conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
9206as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
9207are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009208
9209ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
9210'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
9211which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
9212
9213There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
9214performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
9215
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009216The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
9217specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
9218this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009219methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
9220ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009221
9222Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
9223 - boolean
9224 - integer (signed or unsigned)
9225 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
9226 - string
9227 - data block
9228
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009229Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
9230converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
9231would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
9232The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
9233which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
9234
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009235Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
9236keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
9237fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
9238which are summarized in the table below :
9239
9240 +---------------------+-----------------+
9241 | Sample or converter | Default |
9242 | output type | matching method |
9243 +---------------------+-----------------+
9244 | boolean | bool |
9245 +---------------------+-----------------+
9246 | integer | int |
9247 +---------------------+-----------------+
9248 | ip | ip |
9249 +---------------------+-----------------+
9250 | string | str |
9251 +---------------------+-----------------+
9252 | binary | none, use "-m" |
9253 +---------------------+-----------------+
9254
9255Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
9256matching method, see below.
9257
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009258The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
9259 - boolean
9260 - integer or integer range
9261 - IP address / network
9262 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
9263 - regular expression
9264 - hex block
9265
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009266The following ACL flags are currently supported :
9267
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009268 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
9269 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009270 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01009271 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01009272 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01009273 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009274 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
9275
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009276The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
9277read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
9278if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
9279lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
9280will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
9281beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
9282a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
9283lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
9284exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
9285
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01009286The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
9287parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
9288ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
9289a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
9290check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
9291
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01009292The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
9293socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
9294file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
9295
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009296Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
9297loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
9298
9299 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
9300
9301In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
9302the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
9303case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
9304as well.
9305
9306The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
9307sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
9308do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
9309methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
9310is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
9311obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
9312followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
9313default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
9314that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
9315string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
9316
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01009317The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
9318By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
9319string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
9320resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
9321server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
9322waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
9323flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
9324function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
9325
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009326There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
9327sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
9328be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009329
9330 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
9331 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009332 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
9333 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
9334 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
9335 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009336
9337 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
9338 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009339 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009340
9341 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009342 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009343
9344 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009345 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009346
9347 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
9348 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
9349
9350 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
9351 binary or string samples.
9352
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009353 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
9354 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009355
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009356 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
9357 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
9358 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009359
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009360 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
9361 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009362
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009363 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
9364 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009365
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009366 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
9367 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009368
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009369 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
9370 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009371 This may be used with binary or string samples.
9372
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009373 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
9374 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
9375 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009376
9377For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
9378request, it is possible to do :
9379
9380 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
9381
9382In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
9383buffer, one would use the following acl :
9384
9385 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
9386
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009387On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
9388possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
9389
9390 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
9391
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009392All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
9393criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
9394method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
9395to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
9396criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
9397the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009398
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009399If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009400the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
9401For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009402
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009403 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
9404 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
9405 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
9406 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009407
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009408
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009409The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
9410types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
9411combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
9412brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
9413default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009414
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009415 +-------------------------------------------------+
9416 | Input sample type |
9417 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009418 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009419 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9420 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
9421 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009422 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009423 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009424 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009425 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009426 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009427 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009428 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009429 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009430 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009431 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009432 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009433 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009434 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009435 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009436 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009437 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009438 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009439 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009440 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009441 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009442 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009443 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9444 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
9445 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009446
9447
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020094487.1.1. Matching booleans
9449------------------------
9450
9451In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
9452Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
9453When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
9454that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
9455
9456Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
9457return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
9458"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
9459
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009460
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020094617.1.2. Matching integers
9462------------------------
9463
9464Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
9465enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
9466to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
9467
9468Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
9469matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
9470lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009471
9472For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
9473unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
9474representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
9475
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009476As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
9477two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
9478instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
9479ranges and operators.
9480
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009481For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009482operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
9483Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
9484of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009485
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009486Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009487
9488 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
9489 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
9490 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
9491 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
9492 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
9493
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009494For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009495
9496 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
9497
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009498This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
9499
9500 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
9501
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009502
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020095037.1.3. Matching strings
9504-----------------------
9505
9506String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
9507different forms :
9508
9509 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
9510 patterns ;
9511
9512 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
9513 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
9514
9515 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
9516 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9517
9518 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
9519 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9520
9521 - subdir match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9522 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
9523 matches.
9524
9525 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9526 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
9527 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009528
9529String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
9530exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
9531characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
9532string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
9533to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009534before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009535
9536
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020095377.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
9538---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009539
9540Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
9541they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
9542possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
9543passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
9544the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009545the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
9546match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009547
9548
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020095497.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
9550-------------------------------------
9551
9552It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
9553not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
9554a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
9555to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
9556digits may be used upper or lower case.
9557
9558Example :
9559 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
9560 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
9561
9562
95637.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
9564---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009565
9566IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
9567netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
9568within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009569host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009570difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
9571at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
9572does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
9573parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009574
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009575IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
9576Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
9577trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
9578IPv6 patterns.
9579
9580HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
9581following situations :
9582 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
9583 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
9584 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
9585 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
9586 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
9587 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
9588 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
9589 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
9590 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
9591 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
9592
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009593
95947.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
9595----------------------------------
9596
9597Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
9598combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
9599
9600 - AND (implicit)
9601 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
9602 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009603
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009604A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009605
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009606 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009607
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009608Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
9609indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009610
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009611For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
9612"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
9613requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
9614is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
9615
9616 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9617 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
9618 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
9619 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
9620
9621To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
9622and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
9623
9624 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
9625 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
9626 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
9627 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
9628
9629 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
9630 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
9631 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
9632 use_backend www if host_www
9633
9634It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
9635expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
9636be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
9637the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
9638
9639 The following rule :
9640
9641 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9642 block if METH_POST missing_cl
9643
9644 Can also be written that way :
9645
9646 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
9647
9648It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
9649to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
9650simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
9651sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
9652good use is the following :
9653
9654 With named ACLs :
9655
9656 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
9657 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
9658 monitor fail if site_dead
9659
9660 With anonymous ACLs :
9661
9662 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
9663
9664See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
9665
9666
96677.3. Fetching samples
9668---------------------
9669
9670Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
9671against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
9672sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
9673ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
9674of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
9675available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
9676
9677This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
9678Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
9679compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
9680deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
9681
9682The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
9683matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
9684method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
9685indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
9686
9687As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
9688when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
9689mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
9690the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
9691ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
9692
9693Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
9694multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
9695when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
9696incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
9697are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
9698is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
9699all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
9700
9701Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
9702 - name
9703 - name(arg1)
9704 - name(arg1,arg2)
9705
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009706
97077.3.1. Converters
9708-----------------
9709
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009710Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
9711of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
9712is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
9713was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
9714has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
9715unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
9716
9717These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
9718sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
9719the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
9720support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009721
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009722The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009723
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +02009724base64
9725 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
9726 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
9727 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
9728
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009729lower
9730 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
9731 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
9732 type. The result is of type string.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009733
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009734upper
9735 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
9736 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
9737 type. The result is of type string.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009738
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009739hex
9740 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
9741 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
9742 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
9743 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +01009744
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009745ipmask(<mask>)
9746 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
9747 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
9748 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
9749 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009750
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009751http_date([<offset>])
9752 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
9753 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
9754 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
9755 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
9756 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
9757 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009758
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009759language(<value>[,<default>])
9760 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
9761 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
9762 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
9763 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
9764 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
9765 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
9766 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
9767 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
9768 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
9769 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
9770 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
9771 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009772
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009773 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009774
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009775 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
9776 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009777
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009778 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
9779 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
9780 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
9781 use_backend spanish if es
9782 use_backend french if fr
9783 use_backend english if en
9784 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009785
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009786map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9787map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9788map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9789 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
9790 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
9791 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
9792 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
9793 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
9794 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
9795 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
9796 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009797
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009798 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
9799 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
9800 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009801
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009802 The following array contains the list of all map functions avalaible sorted by
9803 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009804
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009805 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
9806 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9807 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
9808 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +02009809 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
9810 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009811 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
9812 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9813 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
9814 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9815 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
9816 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9817 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
9818 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9819 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
9820 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9821 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
9822 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9823 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
9824 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009825
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009826 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
9827 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
9828 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
9829 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
9830 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009831
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009832 Example :
9833
9834 # this is a comment and is ignored
9835 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
9836 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
9837 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
9838 | | | `---------- value
9839 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
9840 | `---------------------------- key
9841 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
9842
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009843
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020098447.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009845--------------------------------------------
9846
9847A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
9848not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
9849"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
9850The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
9851
9852always_false : boolean
9853 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
9854 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
9855
9856always_true : boolean
9857 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
9858 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
9859
9860avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009861 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009862 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
9863 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
9864 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
9865 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
9866 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
9867 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
9868 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
9869 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
9870 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
9871 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
9872 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
9873 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
9874 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01009875
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009876be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009877 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
9878 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
9879 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
9880 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
9881 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009882
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009883be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
9884 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
9885 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
9886 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
9887 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
9888 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
9889 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009890
9891 Example :
9892 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
9893 backend dynamic
9894 mode http
9895 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
9896 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009897
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009898connslots([<backend>]) : integer
9899 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009900 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009901 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
9902 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -05009903
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009904 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009905 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009906 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
9907
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009908 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
9909 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009910
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009911 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009912 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009913 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009914 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
9915 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009916 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009917 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009918
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009919 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
9920 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009921 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009922 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009923
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +02009924date([<offset>]) : integer
9925 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
9926 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
9927 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
9928 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +02009929 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
9930
9931 Example :
9932
9933 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
9934 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +02009935
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +02009936env(<name>) : string
9937 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
9938 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
9939 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
9940 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
9941 certain way.
9942
9943 Examples :
9944 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
9945 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
9946
9947 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
9948 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
9949
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009950fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
9951 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009952 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
9953 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009954 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
9955 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
9956 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
9957 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
9958 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009959
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009960fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
9961 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
9962 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
9963 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
9964 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
9965 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
9966 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
9967 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
9968 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01009969
9970 Example :
9971 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
9972 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
9973 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
9974 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
9975 frontend mail
9976 bind :25
9977 mode tcp
9978 maxconn 100
9979 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
9980 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
9981 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
9982 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009983
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009984nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
9985 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
9986 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
9987 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009988 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
9989 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
9990 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01009991
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009992queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009993 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
9994 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
9995 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009996 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
9997 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
9998 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
9999 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
10000 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
10001
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010010002rand([<range>]) : integer
10003 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
10004 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
10005 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
10006 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
10007 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
10008
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010009srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
10010 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
10011 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
10012 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
10013 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
10014 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
10015 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
10016 methods.
10017
10018srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
10019 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
10020 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
10021 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
10022 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
10023 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
10024 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
10025 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
10026
10027srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
10028 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10029 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010030 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010031 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
10032 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
10033 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
10034 overloading servers).
10035
10036 Example :
10037 # Redirect to a separate back
10038 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
10039 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
10040 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
10041
10042table_avl([<table>]) : integer
10043 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
10044 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
10045
10046table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10047 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
10048 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
10049 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
10050
10051
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200100527.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010053----------------------------------
10054
10055The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
10056closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
10057methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
10058sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
10059TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010060the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
10061counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
10062"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010063argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
10064the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
10065this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010066
10067be_id : integer
10068 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
10069 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
10070
10071dst : ip
10072 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
10073 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
10074 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
10075 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
10076 RFC 4291.
10077
10078dst_conn : integer
10079 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
10080 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
10081 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
10082 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
10083 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
10084 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
10085 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
10086 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010087
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010088dst_port : integer
10089 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
10090 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
10091 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
10092 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
10093 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
10094 an HTTP header.
10095
10096fe_id : integer
10097 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
10098 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
10099 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
10100
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010101sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010102sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10103sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10104sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010105 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
10106 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
10107 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
10108
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010109sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010110sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10111sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10112sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010113 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
10114 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
10115 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
10116
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010117sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010118sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10119sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10120sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010121 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
10122 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010123 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
10124 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
10125 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010126
10127 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
10128 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010129 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
10130 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
10131 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010132 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
10133 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10134
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010135sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010136sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10137sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10138sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010139 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
10140 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
10141
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010142sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010143sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
10144sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
10145sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010146 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
10147 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
10148 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
10149
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010150sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010151sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10152sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10153sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010154 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
10155 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
10156 See also src_conn_rate.
10157
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010158sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010159sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10160sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10161sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010162 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010163 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010164
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010165sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010166sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
10167sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
10168sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010169 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
10170 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
10171 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010172 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
10173 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
10174 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010175
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010176sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010177sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10178sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10179sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010180 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
10181 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
10182 See also src_http_err_cnt.
10183
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010184sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010185sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10186sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10187sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010188 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
10189 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
10190 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
10191 src_http_err_rate.
10192
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010193sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010194sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10195sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10196sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010197 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
10198 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
10199 src_http_req_cnt.
10200
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010201sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010202sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10203sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10204sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010205 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
10206 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
10207 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
10208 src_http_req_rate.
10209
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010210sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010211sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10212sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10213sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010214 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010215 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
10216 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
10217 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
10218 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010219
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010220 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
10221 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010222 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10223
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010224sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010225sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10226sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10227sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010228 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
10229 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
10230 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
10231 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
10232
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010233sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010234sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10235sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10236sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010237 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
10238 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
10239 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
10240 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
10241
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010242sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010243sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10244sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10245sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010246 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
10247 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
10248 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
10249 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010250 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010251 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
10252
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010253sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010254sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10255sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10256sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010257 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
10258 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
10259 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
10260 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
10261 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010262 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010263
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010264sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010265sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
10266sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
10267sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020010268 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
10269 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
10270 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
10271
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010272sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010273sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
10274sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
10275sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010276 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
10277 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010278 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010279 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
10280 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010281 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
10282 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
10283 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010284
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010285so_id : integer
10286 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
10287 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
10288 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010289
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010290src : ip
10291 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
10292 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
10293 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
10294 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
10295 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
10296 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
10297 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010298
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010299 Example:
10300 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
10301 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
10302
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010303src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10304 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
10305 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
10306 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010307 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010308
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010309src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10310 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
10311 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010312 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010313 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010314
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010315src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10316 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
10317 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10318 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
10319 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
10320 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
10321 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010322
10323 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
10324 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
10325 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
10326 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010327 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010328 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
10329 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10330
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010331src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010332 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010333 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010334 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010335 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010336
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010337src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010338 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010339 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
10340 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010341 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010342
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010343src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10344 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
10345 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10346 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010347 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010348
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010349src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010350 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010351 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010352 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010353 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010354
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010355src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010356 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010357 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010358 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
10359 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010360 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
10361 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
10362 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010363
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010364src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10365 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
10366 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010367 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010368 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010369 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010370
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010371src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10372 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
10373 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10374 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
10375 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010376 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010377
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010378src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10379 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
10380 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
10381 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010382 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010383
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010384src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10385 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
10386 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
10387 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010388 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010389 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010390
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010391src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10392 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
10393 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10394 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010395 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010396 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
10397 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010398
10399 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010400 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010401 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010402
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010403src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10404 Returns the amount of data received from the incoming connection's source
10405 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10406 measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address
10407 is not found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010408 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also
10409 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010410
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010411src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10412 Returns the amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source address
10413 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010414 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
10415 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010416 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010417
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010418src_port : integer
10419 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
10420 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
10421 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
10422 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010423
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010424src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10425 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010426 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10427 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
10428 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010429 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010430
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010431src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10432 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
10433 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10434 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
10435 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010436 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010437
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010438src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10439 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
10440 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
10441 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
10442 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
10443 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
10444 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
10445 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
10446 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010447
10448 Example :
10449 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
10450 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
10451 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
10452 listen ssh
10453 bind :22
10454 mode tcp
10455 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010456 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010457 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010458 server local 127.0.0.1:22
10459
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010460srv_id : integer
10461 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
10462 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
10463 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020010464
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +010010465
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200104667.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010467----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020010468
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010469The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
10470closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
10471when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
10472usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010473future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020010474
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020010475ssl_bc : boolean
10476 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
10477 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
10478 other a server with the "ssl" option.
10479
10480ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
10481 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
10482 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10483
10484ssl_bc_cipher : string
10485 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
10486 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10487
10488ssl_bc_protocol : string
10489 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
10490 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10491
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010492ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020010493 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010494 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
10495 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020010496
10497ssl_bc_session_id : binary
10498 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
10499 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
10500 if session was reused or not.
10501
10502ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
10503 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
10504 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10505
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010506ssl_c_ca_err : integer
10507 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10508 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
10509 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
10510 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
10511 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020010512
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010513ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
10514 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10515 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
10516 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
10517 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010518
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010519ssl_c_err : integer
10520 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10521 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
10522 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
10523 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
10524 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010525
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010526ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10527 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10528 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
10529 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10530 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10531 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10532 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10533 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10534 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010535
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010536ssl_c_key_alg : string
10537 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
10538 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10539 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010540
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010541ssl_c_notafter : string
10542 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
10543 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10544 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020010545
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010546ssl_c_notbefore : string
10547 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
10548 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10549 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010010550
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010551ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10552 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10553 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
10554 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10555 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10556 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10557 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10558 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10559 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010010560
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010561ssl_c_serial : binary
10562 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
10563 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10564 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010565
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010566ssl_c_sha1 : binary
10567 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
10568 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
10569 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010570
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010571ssl_c_sig_alg : string
10572 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
10573 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
10574 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010575
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010576ssl_c_used : boolean
10577 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
10578 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010579
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010580ssl_c_verify : integer
10581 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
10582 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
10583 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
10584 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010585
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010586ssl_c_version : integer
10587 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
10588 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010589
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010590ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10591 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10592 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
10593 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10594 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010595 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010596 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10597 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10598 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010599
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010600ssl_f_key_alg : string
10601 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
10602 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
10603 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010604
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010605ssl_f_notafter : string
10606 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
10607 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10608 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010609
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010610ssl_f_notbefore : string
10611 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
10612 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10613 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010614
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010615ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10616 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10617 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
10618 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10619 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10620 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10621 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10622 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10623 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010624
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010625ssl_f_serial : binary
10626 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
10627 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10628 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010629
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020010630ssl_f_sha1 : binary
10631 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
10632 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
10633 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
10634
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010635ssl_f_sig_alg : string
10636 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
10637 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
10638 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010639
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010640ssl_f_version : integer
10641 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
10642 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10643
10644ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010645 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
10646 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
10647 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
10648
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010649 Example :
10650 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
10651 listen http-https
10652 bind :80
10653 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
10654 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
10655
10656ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
10657 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
10658 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10659
10660ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010661 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010662 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
10663 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
10664 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
10665 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
10666 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
10667 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
10668 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
10669 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
10670
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010671ssl_fc_cipher : string
10672 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
10673 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010674
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010675ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010676 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
10677 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010010678 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
10679 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
10680 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
10681 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010682
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010683ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
10684 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020010685 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
10686 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
10687 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
10688 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010689
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010690ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010691 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010692 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
10693 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
10694 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
10695 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
10696 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
10697 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
10698 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020010699
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010700ssl_fc_protocol : string
10701 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
10702 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010703
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010704ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040010705 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010706 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
10707 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040010708
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010709ssl_fc_session_id : binary
10710 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
10711 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
10712 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
10713 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010714
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010715ssl_fc_sni : string
10716 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
10717 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
10718 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
10719 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
10720 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
10721
10722 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
10723 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
10724 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020010725 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
10726 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010727
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010728 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010729 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
10730 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020010731
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010732ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
10733 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
10734 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010735
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010736
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200107377.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010738------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010739
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010740Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
10741sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
10742only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
10743For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
10744be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
10745can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
10746sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
10747for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
10748content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010749
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010750payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
10751 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
10752 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
10753 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010754
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010755payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
10756 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
10757 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
10758 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010759
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010760req.len : integer
10761req_len : integer (deprecated)
10762 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
10763 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
10764 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
10765 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
10766 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
10767 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
10768 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
10769 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010770
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010771req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
10772 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020010773 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
10774 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
10775 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
10776 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010777
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010778 ACL alternatives :
10779 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010780
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010781req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
10782 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
10783 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
10784 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
10785 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010786
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010787 ACL alternatives :
10788 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010789
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010790 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010791
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010792req.proto_http : boolean
10793req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
10794 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
10795 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
10796 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
10797 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
10798 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
10799 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
10800 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010801
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010802 Example:
10803 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
10804 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
10805 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010806 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010807
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010808req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
10809rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10810 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
10811 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
10812 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
10813 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
10814 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
10815 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
10816 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010817
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010818 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
10819 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
10820 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
10821 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
10822 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
10823 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010824
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010825 ACL derivatives :
10826 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010827
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010828 Example :
10829 listen tse-farm
10830 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
10831 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
10832 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10833 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
10834 # apply RDP cookie persistence
10835 persist rdp-cookie
10836 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
10837 # This is only useful makes sense if
10838 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
10839 stick-table type string size 204800
10840 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
10841 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
10842 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010843
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010844 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
10845 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010846
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010847req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
10848rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
10849 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
10850 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
10851 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
10852 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010853
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010854 ACL derivatives :
10855 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010856
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010857req.ssl_hello_type : integer
10858req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
10859 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
10860 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
10861 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
10862 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
10863 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
10864 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
10865 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010866
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010867req.ssl_sni : string
10868req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
10869 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
10870 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
10871 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
10872 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
10873 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
10874 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
10875 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
10876 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
10877 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
10878 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
10879 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
10880 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010881
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010882 ACL derivatives :
10883 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010884
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010885 Examples :
10886 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
10887 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10888 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
10889 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
10890 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010891
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010892res.ssl_hello_type : integer
10893rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
10894 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
10895 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
10896 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
10897 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
10898 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
10899 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
10900 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +020010901
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010902req.ssl_ver : integer
10903req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
10904 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
10905 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
10906 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
10907 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
10908 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
10909 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
10910 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
10911 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
10912 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010913
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010914 ACL derivatives :
10915 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010916
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020010917res.len : integer
10918 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
10919 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
10920 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
10921 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
10922 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
10923 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
10924 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
10925 content inspection.
10926
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010927res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
10928 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020010929 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
10930 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
10931 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
10932 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010933
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010934res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
10935 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
10936 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
10937 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
10938 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010939
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010940 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010941
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010942wait_end : boolean
10943 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
10944 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
10945 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
10946 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
10947 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
10948 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
10949 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
10950 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010951
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010952 Examples :
10953 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
10954 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
10955 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010956
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010957 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
10958 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
10959 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
10960 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
10961 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
10962 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
10963 tcp-request content reject
10964
10965
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200109667.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010967--------------------------------------
10968
10969It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
10970This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
10971data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
10972its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
10973HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
10974content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
10975to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
10976more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
10977response are indexed.
10978
10979base : string
10980 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
10981 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
10982 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
10983 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
10984 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
10985 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
10986 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
10987 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
10988
10989 ACL derivatives :
10990 base : exact string match
10991 base_beg : prefix match
10992 base_dir : subdir match
10993 base_dom : domain match
10994 base_end : suffix match
10995 base_len : length match
10996 base_reg : regex match
10997 base_sub : substring match
10998
10999base32 : integer
11000 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
11001 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
11002 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
11003 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer.
11004
11005base32+src : binary
11006 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
11007 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
11008 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
11009 per-URL counters.
11010
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010011011capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
11012 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
11013 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
11014 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
11015
11016capture.req.method : string
11017 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
11018 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
11019 because it's allocated.
11020
11021capture.req.uri : string
11022 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
11023 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
11024 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
11025 allocated.
11026
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020011027capture.req.ver : string
11028 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
11029 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
11030 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
11031
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010011032capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
11033 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
11034 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
11035 The first entry is an index of 0.
11036 See also: "capture response header"
11037
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020011038capture.res.ver : string
11039 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
11040 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
11041 persistent flag.
11042
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011043req.cook([<name>]) : string
11044cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11045 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11046 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
11047 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
11048 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
11049 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
11050 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
11051 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
11052 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
11053
11054 ACL derivatives :
11055 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
11056 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
11057 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
11058 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
11059 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
11060 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
11061 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
11062 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011063
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011064req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11065cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11066 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
11067 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011068
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011069req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
11070cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11071 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11072 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
11073 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
11074 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011075
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011076cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11077 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11078 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
11079 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
11080 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
11081 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
11082 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
11083 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
11084 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
11085 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
11086 See also : "appsession".
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011087
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011088hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11089 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
11090 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
11091 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
11092 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011093 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011094
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011095req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
11096 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
11097 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
11098 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11099 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11100 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11101 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
11102 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
11103 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011104
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011105req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11106 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
11107 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11108 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
11109 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011110
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011111req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11112 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
11113 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
11114 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11115 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11116 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11117 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
11118 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
11119 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
11120 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
11121 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
11122 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011123
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011124 ACL derivatives :
11125 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
11126 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
11127 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
11128 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
11129 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
11130 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
11131 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
11132 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
11133
11134req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11135hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
11136 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
11137 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
11138 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
11139 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
11140 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
11141 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
11142 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
11143 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
11144 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
11145
11146req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
11147hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
11148 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
11149 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
11150 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
11151 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
11152 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
11153 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
11154 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
11155 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
11156
11157req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
11158hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
11159 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
11160 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
11161 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
11162 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11163 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11164 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11165 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
11166
11167http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
11168 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
11169 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
11170 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
11171 basic auth is supported.
11172
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010011173http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
11174 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
11175 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
11176 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
11177 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011178 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
11179 basic auth is supported.
11180
11181 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010011182 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
11183 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
11184 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
11185 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011186
11187http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020011188 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
11189 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011190 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
11191 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020011192
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011193method : integer + string
11194 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
11195 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
11196 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
11197 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
11198 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
11199 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
11200 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011201
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011202 ACL derivatives :
11203 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011204
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011205 Example :
11206 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
11207 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
11208 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011209
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011210path : string
11211 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
11212 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
11213 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
11214 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
11215 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
11216 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
11217 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011218
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011219 ACL derivatives :
11220 path : exact string match
11221 path_beg : prefix match
11222 path_dir : subdir match
11223 path_dom : domain match
11224 path_end : suffix match
11225 path_len : length match
11226 path_reg : regex match
11227 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011228
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011229req.ver : string
11230req_ver : string (deprecated)
11231 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
11232 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
11233 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011234
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011235 ACL derivatives :
11236 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011237
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011238res.comp : boolean
11239 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
11240 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
11241 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011242
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011243res.comp_algo : string
11244 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
11245 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
11246 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011247
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011248res.cook([<name>]) : string
11249scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11250 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11251 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
11252 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020011253
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011254 ACL derivatives :
11255 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020011256
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011257res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11258scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11259 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
11260 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
11261 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011262
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011263res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
11264scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11265 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11266 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
11267 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011268
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011269res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11270 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
11271 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
11272 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
11273 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
11274 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
11275 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
11276 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
11277 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
11278 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011279
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011280res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11281 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
11282 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11283 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
11284 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
11285 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011286
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011287res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11288shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
11289 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
11290 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
11291 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
11292 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
11293 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
11294 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
11295 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
11296 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011297
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011298 ACL derivatives :
11299 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
11300 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
11301 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
11302 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
11303 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
11304 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
11305 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
11306 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
11307
11308res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11309shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11310 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
11311 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11312 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
11313 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
11314 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011315
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011316res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
11317shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
11318 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
11319 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
11320 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
11321 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
11322 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
11323 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011324
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011325res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
11326shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
11327 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
11328 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
11329 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
11330 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
11331 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
11332 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010011333
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011334res.ver : string
11335resp_ver : string (deprecated)
11336 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
11337 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011338
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011339 ACL derivatives :
11340 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010011341
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011342set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11343 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11344 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
11345 can be comparable to what "appsession" does with default options, but with
11346 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011347
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011348 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
11349 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011350
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011351 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011352
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011353status : integer
11354 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
11355 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
11356 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011357
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011358url : string
11359 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
11360 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
11361 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
11362 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
11363 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
11364 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
11365 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011366
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011367 ACL derivatives :
11368 url : exact string match
11369 url_beg : prefix match
11370 url_dir : subdir match
11371 url_dom : domain match
11372 url_end : suffix match
11373 url_len : length match
11374 url_reg : regex match
11375 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011376
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011377url_ip : ip
11378 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
11379 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
11380 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
11381 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
11382 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
11383 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
11384 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011385
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011386url_port : integer
11387 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
11388 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
11389 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
11390 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011391
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011392urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
11393url_param(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
11394 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
11395 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
11396 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. The result is a string
11397 corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in the
11398 request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
11399 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
11400 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
11401 this fetch do not iterate over multiple parameters and stop at the first one
11402 as well.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011403
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011404 ACL derivatives :
11405 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
11406 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
11407 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
11408 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
11409 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
11410 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
11411 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
11412 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011413
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011414
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011415 Example :
11416 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
11417 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
11418 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
11419 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011420
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011421urlp_val(<name>[,<delim>]) : integer
11422 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
11423 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
11424 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020011425
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010011426
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200114277.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011428---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011429
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011430Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
11431every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020011432order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011433
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011434ACL name Equivalent to Usage
11435---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011436FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020011437HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011438HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
11439HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011440HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
11441HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
11442HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
11443HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
11444LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011445METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
11446METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
11447METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
11448METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
11449METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
11450METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020011451RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011452REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011453TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011454WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
11455---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011456
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011457
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200114588. Logging
11459----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011460
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011461One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
11462provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
11463very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
11464provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
11465state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011466to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011467headers.
11468
11469In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
11470about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
11471send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
11472
11473 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
11474 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
11475 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
11476 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
11477 at the termination.
11478
11479The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
11480allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
11481as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
11482while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
11483real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
11484delay.
11485
11486
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200114878.1. Log levels
11488---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011489
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011490TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011491source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011492HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
11493in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
11494track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
11495syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
11496about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011497
11498
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200114998.2. Log formats
11500----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011501
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011502HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011503and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
11504slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
11505options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011506
11507 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
11508 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
11509 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
11510 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
11511 extents.
11512
11513 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
11514 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
11515 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
11516 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
11517 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
11518
11519 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
11520 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
11521 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
11522 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
11523 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
11524
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020011525 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
11526 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
11527 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
11528 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
11529
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011530 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
11531
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011532Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
11533specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
11534field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
11535servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
11536always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
11537identifier.
11538
11539Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
11540 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
11541 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
11542 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
11543 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
11544
11545
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200115468.2.1. Default log format
11547-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011548
11549This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
11550as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
11551format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
11552
11553 Example :
11554 listen www
11555 mode http
11556 log global
11557 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11558
11559 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
11560 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
11561 (www/HTTP)
11562
11563 Field Format Extract from the example above
11564 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
11565 2 'Connect from' Connect from
11566 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
11567 4 'to' to
11568 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
11569 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
11570
11571Detailed fields description :
11572 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
11573 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
11574 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
11575 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
11576 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11577 and processed the connection.
11578 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
11579
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011580In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
11581"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
11582connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
11583
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011584It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
11585will eventually disappear.
11586
11587
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200115888.2.2. TCP log format
11589---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011590
11591The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
11592is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
11593information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
11594counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
11595emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
11596environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
11597the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
11598sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011599specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
11600not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
11601fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
11602marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011603
11604 Example :
11605 frontend fnt
11606 mode tcp
11607 option tcplog
11608 log global
11609 default_backend bck
11610
11611 backend bck
11612 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11613
11614 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
11615 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
11616 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
11617
11618 Field Format Extract from the example above
11619 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
11620 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
11621 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
11622 4 frontend_name fnt
11623 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
11624 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
11625 7 bytes_read* 212
11626 8 termination_state --
11627 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
11628 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
11629
11630Detailed fields description :
11631 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011632 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
11633 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
11634 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
11635 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
11636 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011637
11638 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011639 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
11640 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
11641 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011642
11643 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
11644 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
11645 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
11646 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
11647
11648 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11649 and processed the connection.
11650
11651 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
11652 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
11653 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
11654 applications.
11655
11656 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
11657 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
11658 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
11659 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
11660 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
11661
11662 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
11663 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
11664 See "Timers" below for more details.
11665
11666 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
11667 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
11668 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
11669 "Timers" below for more details.
11670
11671 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011672 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011673 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
11674 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
11675 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
11676 details.
11677
11678 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
11679 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
11680 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
11681 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
11682 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
11683
11684 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
11685 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
11686 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
11687 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
11688 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
11689 for more details.
11690
11691 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011692 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011693 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
11694 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
11695 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011696 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011697
11698 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
11699 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
11700 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
11701 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
11702 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
11703 caused by a denial of service attack.
11704
11705 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
11706 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
11707 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
11708 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
11709 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
11710 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
11711 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
11712 denial of service attack.
11713
11714 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
11715 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
11716 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
11717 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
11718 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
11719 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
11720 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
11721 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
11722 be processed than on other servers.
11723
11724 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
11725 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
11726 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
11727 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
11728 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
11729 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
11730 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
11731 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
11732 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
11733 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
11734 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
11735 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
11736 should not be attributed to the logged server.
11737
11738 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11739 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
11740 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
11741 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
11742 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
11743 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
11744 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
11745 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
11746
11747 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11748 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
11749 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
11750 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
11751 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
11752 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
11753 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
11754 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
11755 occurs.
11756
11757
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117588.2.3. HTTP log format
11759----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011760
11761The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
11762is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
11763the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
11764are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
11765emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
11766generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
11767"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
11768which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011769frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
11770is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011771
11772Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
11773slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
11774with a star ('*') after the field name below.
11775
11776 Example :
11777 frontend http-in
11778 mode http
11779 option httplog
11780 log global
11781 default_backend bck
11782
11783 backend static
11784 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11785
11786 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
11787 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
11788 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011789 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011790
11791 Field Format Extract from the example above
11792 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
11793 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
11794 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
11795 4 frontend_name http-in
11796 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
11797 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
11798 7 status_code 200
11799 8 bytes_read* 2750
11800 9 captured_request_cookie -
11801 10 captured_response_cookie -
11802 11 termination_state ----
11803 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
11804 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
11805 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
11806 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
11807 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011808
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011809
11810Detailed fields description :
11811 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011812 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
11813 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
11814 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
11815 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
11816 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011817
11818 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011819 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
11820 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
11821 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011822
11823 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
11824 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
11825 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
11826 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
11827 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
11828
11829 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11830 and processed the connection.
11831
11832 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
11833 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
11834 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
11835
11836 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
11837 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
11838 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
11839 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
11840 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
11841 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
11842
11843 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
11844 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
11845 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
11846 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
11847 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
11848 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
11849
11850 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
11851 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
11852 See "Timers" below for more details.
11853
11854 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
11855 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
11856 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
11857 below for more details.
11858
11859 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
11860 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
11861 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
11862 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
11863 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
11864 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
11865 for more details.
11866
11867 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011868 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011869 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
11870 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
11871 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
11872 details.
11873
11874 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
11875 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
11876 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
11877
11878 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
11879 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
11880 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
11881 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
11882 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
11883 overflowing.
11884
11885 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
11886 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
11887 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
11888 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
11889 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
11890 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
11891 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
11892 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
11893
11894 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
11895 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
11896 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
11897 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
11898 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
11899 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
11900 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
11901 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
11902
11903 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
11904 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
11905 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
11906 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
11907 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
11908 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
11909 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
11910
11911 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011912 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011913 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
11914 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
11915 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011916 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011917 system.
11918
11919 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
11920 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
11921 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
11922 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
11923 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
11924 caused by a denial of service attack.
11925
11926 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
11927 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
11928 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
11929 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
11930 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
11931 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
11932 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
11933 denial of service attack.
11934
11935 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
11936 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
11937 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
11938 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
11939 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
11940 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
11941 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
11942 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
11943 processed than on other servers.
11944
11945 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
11946 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
11947 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
11948 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
11949 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
11950 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
11951 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
11952 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
11953 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
11954 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
11955 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
11956 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
11957 should not be attributed to the logged server.
11958
11959 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11960 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
11961 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
11962 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
11963 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
11964 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
11965 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
11966 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
11967
11968 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11969 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
11970 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
11971 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
11972 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
11973 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
11974 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
11975 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
11976 occurs.
11977
11978 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
11979 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
11980 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
11981 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
11982 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
11983 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
11984 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
11985 cookies" below for more details.
11986
11987 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
11988 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
11989 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
11990 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
11991 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
11992 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
11993 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
11994 and cookies" below for more details.
11995
11996 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
11997 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
11998 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
11999 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
12000 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
12001 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
12002 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
12003 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
12004
12005
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200120068.2.4. Custom log format
12007------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012008
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012009The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012010mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012011
12012HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
12013Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
12014separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
12015prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
12016
12017Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
12018variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
12019string formats ("Q").
12020
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010012021If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012022as a pattern extraction rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010012023less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
12024the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
12025
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012026Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012027In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010012028in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012029
12030Flags are :
12031 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012032 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012033
12034 Example:
12035
12036 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
12037 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
12038
12039At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
12040
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012041 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
12042 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012043
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012044the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012045
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012046 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020012047 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012048 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012049
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012050and the default TCP format is defined this way :
12051
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012052 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012053 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
12054
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012055Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
12056
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012057 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012058 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012059 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
12060 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
12061 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012062 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
12063 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
12064 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012065 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012066 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012067 | H | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012068 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012069 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080012070 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012071 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
12072 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012073 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012074 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
12075 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012076 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012077 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
12078 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012079 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
12080 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
12081 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012082 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012083 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
12084 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012085 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012086 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
12087 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
12088 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020012089 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012090 | H | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
12091 | H | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
12092 | H | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
12093 | H | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012094 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012095 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012096 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012097 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010012098 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012099 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012100 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
12101 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
12102 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012103 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012104 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
12105 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012106 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012107 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012108 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012109 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012110
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012111 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012112
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010012113
121148.2.5. Error log format
12115-----------------------
12116
12117When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
12118protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
12119By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
12120"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
12121will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
12122logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
12123
12124The format looks like this :
12125
12126 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
12127 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
12128 Connection error during SSL handshake
12129
12130 Field Format Extract from the example above
12131 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
12132 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
12133 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
12134 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
12135 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
12136
12137These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
12138failures.
12139
12140
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200121418.3. Advanced logging options
12142-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012143
12144Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
12145just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
12146options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
12147for more information about their usage.
12148
12149
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200121508.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
12151------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012152
12153It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
12154haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
12155commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
12156monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
12157ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
12158
12159 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
12160 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
12161 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
12162 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
12163
12164 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
12165 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
12166 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012167 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012168 such as other load-balancers.
12169
12170 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
12171 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
12172 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
12173
12174
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200121758.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
12176----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012177
12178The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
12179what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
12180or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
12181"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
12182just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
12183log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
12184after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
12185is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
12186with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
12187with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
12188
12189
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200121908.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
12191------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012192
12193Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
12194for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
12195"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
12196retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
12197raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
12198a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
12199file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
12200you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
12201"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
12202
12203
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122048.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
12205--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012206
12207Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
12208multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
12209them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
12210"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
12211logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
12212error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
12213and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
12214too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
12215useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
12216alternative.
12217
12218
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122198.4. Timing events
12220------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012221
12222Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
12223reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
12224the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
12225frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
12226mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
12227
12228 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
12229 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
12230 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
12231 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
12232 the client closes prematurely or times out.
12233
12234 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
12235 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
12236 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
12237 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
12238 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
12239
12240 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
12241 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
12242 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
12243 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
12244 connection never established.
12245
12246 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
12247 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
12248 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
12249 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
12250 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
12251 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
12252 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
12253 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
12254 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
12255 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
12256 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
12257
12258 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
12259 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
12260 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
12261 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012262 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012263
12264 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
12265
12266 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
12267 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
12268 negative.
12269
12270These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
12271protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
12272that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012273due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012274close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
12275session has been aborted on timeout.
12276
12277Most common cases :
12278
12279 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
12280 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
12281 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
12282 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
12283 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
12284 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
12285 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
12286 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
12287 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020012288 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
12289 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
12290 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012291
12292 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
12293 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
12294 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
12295 of ms on remote networks.
12296
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012297 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
12298 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
12299 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012300
12301 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
12302 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
12303 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
12304 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
12305 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
12306 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
12307 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
12308 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
12309 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
12310 to the server until another one is released.
12311
12312Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
12313
12314 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
12315 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
12316 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
12317
12318 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
12319 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
12320 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
12321
12322 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
12323 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
12324 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
12325 flags.
12326
12327 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
12328 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
12329 Check the session termination flags, then check the
12330 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
12331 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
12332 the client connection was maintained open.
12333
12334 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012335 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012336 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
12337 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
12338
12339
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123408.5. Session state at disconnection
12341-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012342
12343TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
12344"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
123452-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
12346each of which has a special meaning :
12347
12348 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
12349 session to terminate :
12350
12351 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
12352
12353 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
12354 server explicitly refused it.
12355
12356 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
12357 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
12358 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
12359 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020012360 (eg: cacheable cookie).
12361
12362 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
12363 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012364
12365 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
12366 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
12367 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
12368 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
12369 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
12370
12371 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
12372 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
12373 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
12374 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
12375 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
12376
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090012377 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
12378 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
12379
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012380 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
12381 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
12382 backup connections when going up.
12383
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020012384 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
12385
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012386 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
12387 send or receive data.
12388
12389 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
12390 send or receive data.
12391
12392 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
12393 with nothing left in the buffers.
12394
12395 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
12396
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010012397 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012398 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
12399
12400 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
12401 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
12402 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
12403 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
12404 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
12405
12406 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
12407 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
12408
12409 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
12410 server (HTTP only).
12411
12412 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
12413
12414 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
12415 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
12416 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
12417
12418 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
12419 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
12420 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
12421
12422 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
12423
12424 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
12425 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
12426
12427 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
12428 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
12429 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
12430
12431 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
12432 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020012433 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
12434 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012435
12436 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
12437 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
12438 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
12439 another server.
12440
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012441 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012442 server.
12443
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012444 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
12445 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
12446 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
12447 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
12448
12449 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
12450 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
12451 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
12452 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
12453
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020012454 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
12455 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
12456 "use-server" rule).
12457
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012458 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
12459
12460 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
12461 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
12462
12463 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
12464
12465 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
12466 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
12467 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
12468
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012469 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
12470 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012471 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012472 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
12473 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
12474
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012475 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
12476
12477 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
12478 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
12479
12480 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
12481
12482 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
12483
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012484The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
12485was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012486helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
12487starvation, attacks, etc...
12488
12489The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
12490alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
12491easier finding and understanding.
12492
12493 Flags Reason
12494
12495 -- Normal termination.
12496
12497 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
12498 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
12499 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
12500 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
12501
12502 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
12503 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
12504 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
12505 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
12506 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
12507 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012508
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012509 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
12510 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012511 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012512
12513 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
12514 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
12515 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
12516
12517 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
12518 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
12519 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
12520 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
12521 the server takes too long to respond.
12522
12523 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
12524 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
12525 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
12526 long a time to respond.
12527
12528 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
12529 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
12530 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
12531 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
12532 and the client.
12533
12534 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
12535 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
12536 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
12537 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
12538 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020012539 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
12540 some browsers such as Google Chrome started to break the deployed Web
12541 infrastructure by aggressively implementing a new "pre-connect"
12542 feature, consisting in sending connections to sites recently visited
12543 without sending any request on them until the user starts to browse
12544 the site. This mechanism causes massive disruption among resource-
12545 limited servers, and causes a lot of 408 errors in HAProxy logs.
12546 Worse, some people report that sometimes the browser displays the 408
12547 error when the user expects to see the actual content (Mozilla fixed
12548 this bug in 2004, while Chrome users continue to report it in 2014),
12549 so in this case, using "errorfile 408 /dev/null" can be used as a
12550 workaround. More information on the subject is available here :
12551 https://bugzilla.mozilla.org/show_bug.cgi?id=248827
12552 https://code.google.com/p/chromium/issues/detail?id=85229
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012553
12554 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
12555 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012556 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
12557 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
12558 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
12559 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012560
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020012561 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
12562 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
12563
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012564 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012565 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
12566 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
12567 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
12568 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
12569 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
12570
12571 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
12572 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
12573 503 or 504 here.
12574
12575 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
12576 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
12577 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
12578 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
12579 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
12580
12581 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
12582 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012583 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012584 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
12585 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
12586
12587 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
12588 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
12589 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
12590 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
12591 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
12592 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
12593 between haproxy and the server.
12594
12595 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
12596 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
12597 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
12598 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
12599 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
12600 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
12601 solution is to fix the application.
12602
12603 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
12604 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
12605 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
12606 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
12607 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
12608 external attacks.
12609
12610 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
12611 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012612 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012613 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
12614 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
12615
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012616 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
12617 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
12618 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020012619 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
12620 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012621
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012622 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
12623 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
12624 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
12625 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012626 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
12627 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
12628 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
12629 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
12630 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012631
12632 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
12633 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
12634 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
12635 returned an HTTP 403 error.
12636
12637 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
12638 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
12639 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
12640 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
12641
12642 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
12643 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
12644 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
12645 only be solved by proper system tuning.
12646
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012647The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
12648persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
12649important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
12650re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
12651
12652 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
12653
12654 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
12655 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
12656 set on a GET request.
12657
12658 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
12659 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012660 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012661 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
12662
12663 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
12664 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
12665 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
12666
12667 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
12668 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
12669 already got a cookie.
12670
12671 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
12672 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
12673 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
12674 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
12675 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
12676
12677 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
12678 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
12679 new cookie was inserted in the response.
12680
12681 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
12682 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
12683 new cookie was inserted in the response.
12684
12685 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
12686 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
12687
12688 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
12689 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
12690 then advertised in the response.
12691
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012692
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200126938.6. Non-printable characters
12694-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012695
12696In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
12697consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
12698converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
12699prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
12700being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
12701escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
12702is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
12703'}' when logging headers.
12704
12705Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
12706issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
12707containing spaces is "User-Agent".
12708
12709Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
12710the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
12711performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
12712
12713
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200127148.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
12715---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012716
12717Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
12718achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012719section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012720cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
12721the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
12722the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012723locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012724not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
12725user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
12726a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
12727wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
12728
12729 Examples :
12730 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
12731 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
12732
12733 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
12734 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
12735
12736
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200127378.8. Capturing HTTP headers
12738---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012739
12740Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
12741proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
12742the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
12743server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
12744
12745Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
12746response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012747section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012748
12749It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012750time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
12751appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012752are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
12753and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
12754follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
12755request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
12756in the logs.
12757
12758 Example :
12759 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
12760 listen proxy-out
12761 mode http
12762 option httplog
12763 option logasap
12764 log global
12765 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
12766
12767 # log the name of the virtual server
12768 capture request header Host len 20
12769
12770 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
12771 capture request header Content-Length len 10
12772
12773 # log the beginning of the referrer
12774 capture request header Referer len 20
12775
12776 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
12777 capture response header Server len 20
12778
12779 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
12780 capture response header Content-Length len 10
12781
12782 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
12783 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
12784
12785 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
12786 capture response header Via len 20
12787
12788 # log the URL location during a redirection
12789 capture response header Location len 20
12790
12791 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
12792 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
12793 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
12794 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
12795 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
12796
12797 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
12798 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
12799 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
12800 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012801 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012802
12803 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
12804 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
12805 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
12806 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
12807 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012808 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012809
12810
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128118.9. Examples of logs
12812---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012813
12814These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
12815them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
12816reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
12817
12818 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
12819 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
12820 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
12821
12822 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
12823 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
12824
12825 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
12826 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
12827 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
12828
12829 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
12830 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
12831
12832 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
12833 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
12834 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
12835
12836 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012837 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012838 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
12839 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
12840
12841 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
12842 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
12843 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
12844
12845 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
12846 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020012847 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012848 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
12849 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
12850 to return the 502 and not the server.
12851
12852 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012853 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012854
12855 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
12856 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
12857 Nothing was sent to any server.
12858
12859 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
12860 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
12861
12862 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
12863 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
12864 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
12865 send a 408 return code to the client.
12866
12867 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
12868 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
12869
12870 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
12871 5 seconds ("c----").
12872
12873 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
12874 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012875 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012876
12877 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012878 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012879 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
12880 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
12881 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
12882 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
12883 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012884
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012885
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128869. Statistics and monitoring
12887----------------------------
12888
12889It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
12890mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
12891CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
12892Unix socket.
12893
12894
128959.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012896---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012897
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010012898The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
12899page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
12900
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012901 0. pxname: proxy name
12902 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
12903 for server)
12904 2. qcur: current queued requests
12905 3. qmax: max queued requests
12906 4. scur: current sessions
12907 5. smax: max sessions
12908 6. slim: sessions limit
12909 7. stot: total sessions
12910 8. bin: bytes in
12911 9. bout: bytes out
12912 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012913 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012914 12. ereq: request errors
12915 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010012916 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012917 15. wretr: retries (warning)
12918 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +010012919 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012920 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
12921 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
12922 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
12923 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
12924 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
12925 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
12926 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
12927 25. qlimit: queue limit
12928 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
12929 27. iid: unique proxy id
12930 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
12931 29. throttle: warm up status
12932 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
12933 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +020012934 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +020012935 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
12936 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
12937 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020012938 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010012939 UNK -> unknown
12940 INI -> initializing
12941 SOCKERR -> socket error
12942 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
12943 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
12944 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
12945 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
12946 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
12947 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
12948 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
12949 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
12950 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
12951 disable-on-404
12952 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
12953 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
12954 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020012955 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
12956 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012957 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
12958 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
12959 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
12960 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
12961 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
12962 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012963 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
12964 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
12965 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
12966 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010012967 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
12968 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau55058a72012-11-21 08:27:21 +010012969 51. comp_in: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
12970 52. comp_out: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
12971 53. comp_byp: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor (CPU/BW limit)
Willy Tarreau11d4ec82012-11-26 00:49:03 +010012972 54. comp_rsp: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
Willy Tarreauf522f3d2014-02-10 22:22:49 +010012973 55. lastsess: number of seconds since last session assigned to server/backend
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012974
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012975
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129769.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012977-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012978
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020012979The stats socket is not enabled by default. In order to enable it, it is
12980necessary to add one line in the global section of the haproxy configuration.
12981A second line is recommended to set a larger timeout, always appreciated when
12982issuing commands by hand :
12983
12984 global
12985 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
12986 stats timeout 2m
12987
12988It is also possible to add multiple instances of the stats socket by repeating
12989the line, and make them listen to a TCP port instead of a UNIX socket. This is
12990never done by default because this is dangerous, but can be handy in some
12991situations :
12992
12993 global
12994 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
12995 stats socket ipv4@192.168.0.1:9999 level admin
12996 stats timeout 2m
12997
12998To access the socket, an external utility such as "socat" is required. Socat is a
12999swiss-army knife to connect anything to anything. We use it to connect terminals
13000to the socket, or a couple of stdin/stdout pipes to it for scripts. The two main
13001syntaxes we'll use are the following :
13002
13003 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock stdio
13004 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock readline
13005
13006The first one is used with scripts. It is possible to send the output of a
13007script to haproxy, and pass haproxy's output to another script. That's useful
13008for retrieving counters or attack traces for example.
13009
13010The second one is only useful for issuing commands by hand. It has the benefit
13011that the terminal is handled by the readline library which supports line
13012editing and history, which is very convenient when issuing repeated commands
13013(eg: watch a counter).
13014
13015The socket supports two operation modes :
13016 - interactive
13017 - non-interactive
13018
13019The non-interactive mode is the default when socat connects to the socket. In
13020this mode, a single line may be sent. It is processed as a whole, responses are
13021sent back, and the connection closes after the end of the response. This is the
13022mode that scripts and monitoring tools use. It is possible to send multiple
13023commands in this mode, they need to be delimited by a semi-colon (';'). For
13024example :
13025
13026 # echo "show info;show stat;show table" | socat /var/run/haproxy stdio
13027
13028The interactive mode displays a prompt ('>') and waits for commands to be
13029entered on the line, then processes them, and displays the prompt again to wait
13030for a new command. This mode is entered via the "prompt" command which must be
13031sent on the first line in non-interactive mode. The mode is a flip switch, if
13032"prompt" is sent in interactive mode, it is disabled and the connection closes
13033after processing the last command of the same line.
13034
13035For this reason, when debugging by hand, it's quite common to start with the
13036"prompt" command :
13037
13038 # socat /var/run/haproxy readline
13039 prompt
13040 > show info
13041 ...
13042 >
13043
13044Since multiple commands may be issued at once, haproxy uses the empty line as a
13045delimiter to mark an end of output for each command, and takes care of ensuring
13046that no command can emit an empty line on output. A script can thus easily
13047parse the output even when multiple commands were pipelined on a single line.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013048
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013049It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
13050on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
13051own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013052
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020013053The list of commands currently supported on the stats socket is provided below.
13054If an unknown command is sent, haproxy displays the usage message which reminds
13055all supported commands. Some commands support a more complex syntax, generally
13056it will explain what part of the command is invalid when this happens.
13057
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013058add acl <acl> <pattern>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013059 Add an entry into the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by
13060 "show acl". This command does not verify if the entry already exists. This
13061 command cannot be used if the reference <acl> is a file also used with a map.
13062 In this case, you must use the command "add map" in place of "add acl".
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013063
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013064add map <map> <key> <value>
13065 Add an entry into the map <map> to associate the value <value> to the key
13066 <key>. This command does not verify if the entry already exists. It is
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013067 mainly used to fill a map after a clear operation. Note that if the reference
13068 <map> is a file and is shared with a map, this map will contain also a new
13069 pattern entry.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013070
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013071clear counters
13072 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
13073 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
13074 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
13075 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
13076 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
13077
13078clear counters all
13079 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
13080 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
13081 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
13082
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013083clear acl <acl>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013084 Remove all entries from the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file>
13085 returned by "show acl". Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and is
13086 shared with a map, this map will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013087
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013088clear map <map>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013089 Remove all entries from the map <map>. <map> is the #<id> or the <file>
13090 returned by "show map". Note that if the reference <map> is a file and is
13091 shared with a acl, this acl will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013092
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013093clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
13094 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
13095
13096 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
13097 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
13098 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
13099 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
13100 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
13101 later after the session ends is usual enough.
13102
13103 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
13104
13105 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
13106 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
13107 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
13108 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
13109 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
13110 the ACLs :
13111
13112 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
13113 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
13114 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
13115 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
13116 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
13117 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
13118
13119 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090013120 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
13121 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013122
13123 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013124 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020013125 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013126 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
13127 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
13128 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13129 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013130
13131 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13132
13133 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020013134 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013135 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13136 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013137 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13138 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13139 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013140
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013141del acl <acl> [<key>|#<ref>]
13142 Delete all the acl entries from the acl <acl> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013143 <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show acl". If the <ref> is used,
13144 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
13145 listing the content of the acl. Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and
13146 is shared with a map, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013147
13148del map <map> [<key>|#<ref>]
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010013149 Delete all the map entries from the map <map> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013150 <map> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used,
13151 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
13152 listing the content of the map. Note that if the reference <map> is a file and
13153 is shared with a acl, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010013154
13155disable agent <backend>/<server>
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090013156 Mark the auxiliary agent check as temporarily stopped.
13157
13158 In the case where an agent check is being run as a auxiliary check, due
13159 to the agent-check parameter of a server directive, new checks are only
13160 initialised when the agent is in the enabled. Thus, disable agent will
13161 prevent any new agent checks from begin initiated until the agent
13162 re-enabled using enable agent.
13163
13164 When an agent is disabled the processing of an auxiliary agent check that
13165 was initiated while the agent was set as enabled is as follows: All
13166 results that would alter the weight, specifically "drain" or a weight
13167 returned by the agent, are ignored. The processing of agent check is
13168 otherwise unchanged.
13169
13170 The motivation for this feature is to allow the weight changing effects
13171 of the agent checks to be paused to allow the weight of a server to be
13172 configured using set weight without being overridden by the agent.
13173
13174 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13175 level "admin".
13176
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013177disable frontend <frontend>
13178 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
13179 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
13180 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
13181 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
13182 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
13183 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
13184 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
13185 on the stats page.
13186
13187 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13188 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13189
13190 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13191 level "admin".
13192
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020013193disable health <backend>/<server>
13194 Mark the primary health check as temporarily stopped. This will disable
13195 sending of health checks, and the last health check result will be ignored.
13196 The server will be in unchecked state and considered UP unless an auxiliary
13197 agent check forces it down.
13198
13199 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13200 level "admin".
13201
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013202disable server <backend>/<server>
13203 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
13204 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
13205 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
13206 during the maintenance.
13207
13208 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
13209 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
13210
13211 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013212 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013213
13214 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13215 level "admin".
13216
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090013217enable agent <backend>/<server>
13218 Resume auxiliary agent check that was temporarily stopped.
13219
13220 See "disable agent" for details of the effect of temporarily starting
13221 and stopping an auxiliary agent.
13222
13223 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13224 level "admin".
13225
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013226enable frontend <frontend>
13227 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
13228 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
13229 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
13230 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
13231 which was disabled.
13232
13233 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13234 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13235
13236 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13237 level "admin".
13238
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020013239enable health <backend>/<server>
13240 Resume a primary health check that was temporarily stopped. This will enable
13241 sending of health checks again. Please see "disable health" for details.
13242
13243 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13244 level "admin".
13245
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013246enable server <backend>/<server>
13247 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
13248 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
13249
13250 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013251 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013252
13253 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13254 level "admin".
13255
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010013256get map <map> <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013257get acl <acl> <value>
13258 Lookup the value <value> in the map <map> or in the ACL <acl>. <map> or <acl>
13259 are the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map" or "show acl". This command
13260 returns all the matching patterns associated with this map. This is useful for
13261 debugging maps and ACLs. The output format is composed by one line par
13262 matching type. Each line is composed by space-delimited series of words.
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010013263
13264 The first two words are:
13265
13266 <match method>: The match method applied. It can be "found", "bool",
13267 "int", "ip", "bin", "len", "str", "beg", "sub", "dir",
13268 "dom", "end" or "reg".
13269
13270 <match result>: The result. Can be "match" or "no-match".
13271
13272 The following words are returned only if the pattern matches an entry.
13273
13274 <index type>: "tree" or "list". The internal lookup algorithm.
13275
13276 <case>: "case-insensitive" or "case-sensitive". The
13277 interpretation of the case.
13278
13279 <entry matched>: match="<entry>". Return the matched pattern. It is
13280 useful with regular expressions.
13281
13282 The two last word are used to show the returned value and its type. With the
13283 "acl" case, the pattern doesn't exist.
13284
13285 return=nothing: No return because there are no "map".
13286 return="<value>": The value returned in the string format.
13287 return=cannot-display: The value cannot be converted as string.
13288
13289 type="<type>": The type of the returned sample.
13290
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013291get weight <backend>/<server>
13292 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
13293 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
13294 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
13295 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
13296 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013297 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013298
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013299help
13300 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
13301 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013302
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013303prompt
13304 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
13305 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
13306 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
13307 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
13308 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
13309 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
13310 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
13311 command.
13312
13313quit
13314 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013315
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013316set map <map> [<key>|#<ref>] <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013317 Modify the value corresponding to each key <key> in a map <map>. <map> is the
13318 #<id> or <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used in place of
13319 <key>, only the entry pointed by <ref> is changed. The new value is <value>.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013320
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020013321set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020013322 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
13323 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
13324 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
13325 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
13326 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020013327 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
13328 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13329
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020013330set maxconn global <maxconn>
13331 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
13332 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
13333 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
13334 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
13335 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
13336 setting.
13337
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020013338set rate-limit connections global <value>
13339 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
13340 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13341 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13342 is passed in number of connections per second.
13343
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010013344set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
13345 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
13346 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010013347 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
13348 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010013349
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +020013350set rate-limit sessions global <value>
13351 Change the process-wide session rate limit, which is set by the global
13352 'maxsessrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13353 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13354 is passed in number of sessions per second.
13355
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +020013356set rate-limit ssl-sessions global <value>
13357 Change the process-wide SSL session rate limit, which is set by the global
13358 'maxsslrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13359 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13360 is passed in number of sessions per second sent to the SSL stack. It applies
13361 before the handshake in order to protect the stack against handshake abuses.
13362
Willy Tarreau2a4b70f2014-05-22 18:42:35 +020013363set server <backend>/<server> agent [ up | down ]
13364 Force a server's agent to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
13365 switch a server's state regardless of some slow agent checks for example.
13366 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
13367
13368set server <backend>/<server> health [ up | stopping | down ]
13369 Force a server's health to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
13370 switch a server's state regardless of some slow health checks for example.
13371 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
13372
13373set server <backend>/<server> state [ ready | drain | maint ]
13374 Force a server's administrative state to a new state. This can be useful to
13375 disable load balancing and/or any traffic to a server. Setting the state to
13376 "ready" puts the server in normal mode, and the command is the equivalent of
13377 the "enable server" command. Setting the state to "maint" disables any traffic
13378 to the server as well as any health checks. This is the equivalent of the
13379 "disable server" command. Setting the mode to "drain" only removes the server
13380 from load balancing but still allows it to be checked and to accept new
13381 persistent connections. Changes are propagated to tracking servers if any.
13382
13383set server <backend>/<server> weight <weight>[%]
13384 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. This is the exact
13385 equivalent of the "set weight" command below.
13386
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020013387set table <table> key <key> [data.<data_type> <value>]*
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020013388 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
13389 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
13390 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
13391 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020013392 IP address or affect its quality of service. It is possible to pass multiple
13393 data_types in a single call.
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020013394
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013395set timeout cli <delay>
13396 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
13397 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
13398 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
13399
13400set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
13401 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
13402 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
Simon Horman58b5d292013-02-12 10:45:52 +090013403 configured weight. Absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256.
13404 Relative weights must be positive with the resulting absolute weight is
13405 capped at 256. Servers which are part of a farm running a static
13406 load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations because the weight
13407 cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only accepted values
13408 are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take effect
13409 immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
13410 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to
13411 disable a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to
13412 enable it again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command
13413 is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for level
13414 "admin". Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their
13415 name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013416
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013417show errors [<iid>]
13418 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
13419 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020013420 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
13421 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
13422 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013423
13424 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
13425 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
13426 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
13427 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
13428 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
13429 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
13430 are reported too.
13431
13432 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
13433 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
13434 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
13435 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
13436 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
13437 code.
13438
13439 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
13440 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
13441 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
13442 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
13443 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
13444 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
13445 line.
13446
13447 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013448 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13449 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013450 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
13451 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
13452
13453 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
13454 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
13455 00038 Location: blah\r\n
13456 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
13457 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
13458 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
13459 00204+ minal\r\n
13460 00211 \r\n
13461
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013462 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013463 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
13464 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
13465 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
13466 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
13467 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
13468 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013469
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013470show info
13471 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
13472
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013473show map [<map>]
13474 Dump info about map converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013475 maps is returned. If a <map> is specified, its contents are dumped. <map> is
13476 the #<id> or <file>. The first column is a unique identifier. It can be used
13477 as reference for the operation "del map" and "set map". The second column is
13478 the pattern and the third column is the sample if available. The data returned
13479 are not directly a list of available maps, but are the list of all patterns
13480 composing any map. Many of these patterns can be shared with ACL.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013481
13482show acl [<acl>]
13483 Dump info about acl converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013484 acls is returned. If a <acl> is specified, its contents are dumped. <acl> if
13485 the #<id> or <file>. The dump format is the same than the map even for the
13486 sample value. The data returned are not a list of available ACL, but are the
13487 list of all patterns composing any ACL. Many of these patterns can be shared
13488 with maps.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013489
Willy Tarreau12833bb2014-01-28 16:49:56 +010013490show pools
13491 Dump the status of internal memory pools. This is useful to track memory
13492 usage when suspecting a memory leak for example. It does exactly the same
13493 as the SIGQUIT when running in foreground except that it does not flush
13494 the pools.
13495
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013496show sess
13497 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020013498 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
13499 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
13500
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010013501show sess <id>
13502 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
13503 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
13504 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
13505 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
13506 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Willy Tarreau76153662012-11-26 01:16:39 +010013507 freely evolve depending on demands. The special id "all" dumps the states of
13508 all sessions, which can be avoided as much as possible as it is highly CPU
13509 intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013510
13511show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
13512 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
13513 possible to dump only selected items :
13514 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
13515 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
13516 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
13517 for example:
13518 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
13519 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
13520 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
13521
13522 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013523 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
13524 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013525 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
13526 Release_date: 2009/09/23
13527 Nbproc: 1
13528 Process_num: 1
13529 (...)
13530
13531 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
13532 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
13533 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
13534 (...)
13535 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
13536
13537 $
13538
13539 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
13540 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
13541 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
13542 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013543 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013544
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013545show table
13546 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
13547 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
13548 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
13549 entries currently in use.
13550
13551 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013552 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013553 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
13554 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013555
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013556show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013557 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
13558 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
13559 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013560 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
13561
13562 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
13563 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
13564 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
13565 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
13566 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
13567
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013568 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
13569 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
13570 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
13571 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
13572 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
13573 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
13574
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013575
13576 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090013577 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
13578 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013579
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013580 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013581 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013582 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013583 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
13584 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
13585 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13586 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013587
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013588 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013589 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013590 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13591 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013592
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013593 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
13594 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013595 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013596 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13597 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013598
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013599 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
13600 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013601 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013602 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13603 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
13604
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013605 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
13606 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
13607 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
13608 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
13609 time goes, the average event rate drops.
13610
13611 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
13612 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
13613 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013614 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
13615 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013616 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
13617 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020013618
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013619shutdown frontend <frontend>
13620 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
13621 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
13622 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
13623 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
13624 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
13625 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
13626 once it is terminated.
13627
13628 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13629 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13630
13631 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13632 level "admin".
13633
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020013634shutdown session <id>
13635 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
13636 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
13637 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
13638 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
13639 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
13640 flag in the logs.
13641
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020013642shutdown sessions <backend>/<server>
13643 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
13644 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
13645 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
13646 'K' flag in the logs.
13647
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013648/*
13649 * Local variables:
13650 * fill-column: 79
13651 * End:
13652 */